PR c/21160
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob9804bcf3c6d493b1ab2413e33fe4890d8363c034
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
23 02111-1307, USA. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83 CIE = Common Information Entry
84 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86 FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 how to restore registers
90 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
93 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
94 translation unit. */
96 int
97 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
99 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
100 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
101 #ifdef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
102 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
103 #endif
104 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
105 || flag_unwind_tables
106 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
107 #endif
111 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
112 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
113 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
114 #endif
116 /* Various versions of targetm.eh_frame_section. Note these must appear
117 outside the DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO macro guards. */
119 /* Version of targetm.eh_frame_section for systems with named sections. */
120 void
121 named_section_eh_frame_section (void)
123 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
124 int flags;
126 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
128 int fde_encoding;
129 int per_encoding;
130 int lsda_encoding;
132 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
133 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
134 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
135 flags = (! flag_pic
136 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
137 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
138 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
139 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
140 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
141 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
142 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE;
144 else
145 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
146 named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags);
147 #endif
150 /* Version of targetm.eh_frame_section for systems using collect2. */
151 void
152 collect2_eh_frame_section (void)
154 tree label = get_file_function_name ('F');
156 data_section ();
157 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
158 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
159 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
162 /* Default version of targetm.eh_frame_section. */
163 void
164 default_eh_frame_section (void)
166 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
167 named_section_eh_frame_section ();
168 #else
169 collect2_eh_frame_section ();
170 #endif
173 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
174 must be kept around forever. */
175 static GTY(()) varray_type used_rtx_varray;
177 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
178 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
179 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
180 it. */
181 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
183 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
184 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
185 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
186 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
187 define type declaration DIE's. */
188 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
190 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
191 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
192 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
193 #endif
195 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
196 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
197 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
199 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
200 Information instructions. The register number, offset
201 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
202 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
204 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
205 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
206 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
207 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
208 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
209 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
212 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
214 unsigned long GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
215 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
216 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
217 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
219 dw_cfi_oprnd;
221 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
223 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
224 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
225 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
226 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
227 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
228 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
230 dw_cfi_node;
232 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
233 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
234 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
235 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
236 of this structure. */
237 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
239 unsigned long reg;
240 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
241 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
242 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
243 } dw_cfa_location;
245 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
246 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
247 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
248 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
249 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
251 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
253 tree decl;
254 const char *dw_fde_begin;
255 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
256 const char *dw_fde_end;
257 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
258 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
259 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
260 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
261 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
262 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
263 unsigned funcdef_number;
264 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
265 unsigned nothrow : 1;
266 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
268 dw_fde_node;
270 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
271 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
273 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
274 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
275 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
276 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
277 pointers. */
278 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
279 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
280 #endif
282 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
283 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
284 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
285 as PTR_SIZE. */
287 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
288 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
289 #endif
291 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
292 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
293 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
294 bytes.
296 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
297 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
299 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
300 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
301 #endif
303 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
305 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
306 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
307 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
309 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
310 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
311 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
312 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
313 #else
314 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
315 #endif
316 #endif
318 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
319 information for each routine. */
320 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
322 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
323 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
325 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
326 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
328 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
329 fde_table. */
330 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
332 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
333 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
335 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
336 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
337 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
338 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
339 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
340 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
341 #endif
343 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
345 const char *str;
346 unsigned int refcount;
347 unsigned int form;
348 char *label;
351 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
353 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
354 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
356 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
358 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
360 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
361 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
362 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
363 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
364 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
365 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
366 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
367 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
368 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
369 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
370 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
371 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
372 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
373 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
374 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
375 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
377 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
378 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
379 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
380 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
381 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
382 (dw_cfa_location *);
383 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
385 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
386 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
387 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
388 #endif
390 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
391 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
392 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
394 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
395 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
396 #endif
398 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
399 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
400 #endif
402 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
403 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
404 #endif
406 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
407 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
408 #endif
409 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
410 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
411 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
412 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
413 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
414 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
415 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
416 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
417 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
418 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
420 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
421 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
422 registers. */
423 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
424 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
425 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
426 #else
427 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
428 #endif
429 #endif
431 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
432 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
433 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
434 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
435 #endif
437 /* The offset from the incoming value of %sp to the top of the stack frame
438 for the current function. */
439 #ifndef INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
440 #define INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 0
441 #endif
443 /* Hook used by __throw. */
446 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
448 return GEN_INT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
451 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
452 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
454 static inline char *
455 stripattributes (const char *s)
457 char *stripped = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 2);
458 char *p = stripped;
460 *p++ = '*';
462 while (*s && *s != ',')
463 *p++ = *s++;
465 *p = '\0';
466 return stripped;
469 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
471 void
472 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
474 int i;
475 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
476 rtx addr = expand_expr (address, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
477 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
478 bool wrote_return_column = false;
480 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
481 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
483 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
484 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
485 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
487 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
488 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
489 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
491 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
492 continue;
493 wrote_return_column = true;
495 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
496 if (offset < 0)
497 continue;
499 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
502 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
503 gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
504 i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
505 wrote_return_column = false;
506 #else
507 i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
508 #endif
510 if (! wrote_return_column)
512 enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
513 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
514 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
515 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
519 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
521 static const char *
522 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
524 switch (cfi_opc)
526 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
527 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
528 case DW_CFA_offset:
529 return "DW_CFA_offset";
530 case DW_CFA_restore:
531 return "DW_CFA_restore";
532 case DW_CFA_nop:
533 return "DW_CFA_nop";
534 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
535 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
536 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
537 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
538 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
539 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
540 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
541 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
542 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
543 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
544 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
545 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
546 case DW_CFA_undefined:
547 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
548 case DW_CFA_same_value:
549 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
550 case DW_CFA_register:
551 return "DW_CFA_register";
552 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
553 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
554 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
555 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
556 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
557 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
558 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
559 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
560 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
561 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
563 /* DWARF 3 */
564 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
565 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
566 case DW_CFA_expression:
567 return "DW_CFA_expression";
568 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
569 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
570 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
571 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
572 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
573 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
575 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
576 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
577 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
579 /* GNU extensions */
580 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
581 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
582 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
583 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
584 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
585 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
587 default:
588 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
592 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
594 static inline dw_cfi_ref
595 new_cfi (void)
597 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
599 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
600 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
601 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
603 return cfi;
606 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
608 static inline void
609 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
611 dw_cfi_ref *p;
613 /* Find the end of the chain. */
614 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
617 *p = cfi;
620 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
622 char *
623 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
625 static char label[20];
627 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
628 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
629 return label;
632 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
633 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
635 static void
636 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
638 if (label)
640 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
642 if (*label == 0)
643 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
645 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
646 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
648 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
650 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
652 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
653 xcfi = new_cfi ();
654 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
655 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
656 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
659 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
662 else
663 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
666 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
668 static inline void
669 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
671 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
673 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
674 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
675 break;
676 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
677 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
678 break;
679 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
680 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
681 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
682 break;
683 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
684 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
685 break;
686 default:
687 break;
691 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
693 static void
694 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
696 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
698 loc->reg = (unsigned long) -1;
699 loc->offset = 0;
700 loc->indirect = 0;
701 loc->base_offset = 0;
703 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
704 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
706 if (fde_table_in_use)
708 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
709 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
710 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
714 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
715 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
717 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
718 from the CFA. */
719 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
721 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
722 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
724 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
725 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
727 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
728 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
729 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
731 void
732 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
734 dw_cfa_location loc;
735 loc.indirect = 0;
736 loc.base_offset = 0;
737 loc.reg = reg;
738 loc.offset = offset;
739 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
742 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
743 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
745 static void
746 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
748 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
749 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
751 cfa = *loc_p;
752 loc = *loc_p;
754 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
755 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
757 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
758 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
760 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
761 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
762 && loc.indirect == old_cfa.indirect
763 && (loc.indirect == 0 || loc.base_offset == old_cfa.base_offset))
764 return;
766 cfi = new_cfi ();
768 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
770 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction,
771 indicating the CFA register did not change but the offset
772 did. */
773 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
774 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
777 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
778 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset && old_cfa.reg != (unsigned long) -1
779 && !loc.indirect)
781 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
782 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
783 offset has not changed. */
784 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
785 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
787 #endif
789 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
791 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
792 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
793 the specified offset. */
794 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
795 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
796 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
798 else
800 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
801 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
802 register-offset pair is available. */
803 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
805 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
806 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc);
807 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
810 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
813 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
814 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
815 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
816 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
818 static void
819 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
821 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
823 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
825 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
827 if (reg & ~0x3f)
828 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
829 the long form. */
830 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
831 else
832 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
834 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
836 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
837 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
838 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
839 description. */
840 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
842 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
844 #endif
845 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
846 if (offset < 0)
847 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
849 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
851 else if (sreg == reg)
852 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
853 else
855 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
856 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
859 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
862 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
863 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
864 from the previous frame's window save area.
866 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
867 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
869 void
870 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
872 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
874 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
875 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
878 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
879 pushed onto the stack. */
881 void
882 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
884 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
886 if (size == old_args_size)
887 return;
889 old_args_size = size;
891 cfi = new_cfi ();
892 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
893 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
894 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
897 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
898 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
900 void
901 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
903 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
906 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
907 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
909 void
910 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
912 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
915 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
916 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
918 void
919 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
921 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
924 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
925 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
927 static void
928 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
930 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
931 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
933 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
935 case REG:
936 /* RA is in a register. */
937 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
938 break;
940 case MEM:
941 /* RA is on the stack. */
942 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
943 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
945 case REG:
946 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
947 offset = 0;
948 break;
950 case PLUS:
951 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
952 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
953 break;
955 case MINUS:
956 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
957 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
958 break;
960 default:
961 gcc_unreachable ();
964 break;
966 case PLUS:
967 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
968 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
969 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
970 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
971 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
972 return;
974 default:
975 gcc_unreachable ();
978 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
979 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
982 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
983 contains. */
985 static HOST_WIDE_INT
986 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
988 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
989 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
990 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
991 enum rtx_code code;
993 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
995 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
996 code = GET_CODE (src);
997 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
998 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
999 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1000 return 0;
1002 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1003 if (code == PLUS)
1004 offset = -offset;
1006 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1008 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1009 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1010 code = GET_CODE (src);
1012 switch (code)
1014 case PRE_MODIFY:
1015 case POST_MODIFY:
1016 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1018 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1019 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1020 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1021 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1022 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1023 break;
1025 return 0;
1027 case PRE_DEC:
1028 case POST_DEC:
1029 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1031 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1032 break;
1034 return 0;
1036 case PRE_INC:
1037 case POST_INC:
1038 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1040 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1041 break;
1043 return 0;
1045 default:
1046 return 0;
1049 else
1050 return 0;
1052 return offset;
1055 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1056 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1057 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1059 static void
1060 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1062 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1063 const char *label;
1064 int i;
1066 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1067 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1068 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1069 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1070 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1071 return;
1073 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1074 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1075 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1077 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1079 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1080 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1081 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1082 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1083 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1084 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1085 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1086 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1088 return;
1091 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1093 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1094 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1095 return;
1097 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1099 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1100 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1101 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1102 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1103 offset = -args_size;
1104 #else
1105 offset = args_size;
1106 #endif
1108 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1109 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1110 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1111 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1113 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1114 for them. */
1115 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1116 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1117 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1119 else
1120 return;
1122 if (offset == 0)
1123 return;
1125 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1126 cfa.offset += offset;
1128 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1129 offset = -offset;
1130 #endif
1132 args_size += offset;
1133 if (args_size < 0)
1134 args_size = 0;
1136 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1137 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1138 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1139 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1142 #endif
1144 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1145 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1146 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1148 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1150 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1151 rtx reg;
1152 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1153 rtx saved_reg;
1156 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1158 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1159 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1160 rtx orig_reg;
1161 rtx saved_in_reg;
1164 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1165 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1166 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1167 more efficient data structure. */
1168 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1169 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1171 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1172 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1174 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1175 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1177 static void
1178 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1180 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1182 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1183 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1184 order. */
1185 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1186 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1187 break;
1189 if (q == NULL)
1191 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1192 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1193 queued_reg_saves = q;
1196 q->reg = reg;
1197 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1198 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1200 last_reg_save_label = label;
1203 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1205 static void
1206 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1208 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1210 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1212 size_t i;
1213 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1215 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1216 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1217 break;
1218 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1220 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1221 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1223 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1225 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1226 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1229 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1230 if (q->saved_reg)
1231 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1232 else
1233 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1234 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1237 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1238 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1241 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1242 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1243 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1244 have a new location for? */
1246 static bool
1247 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1249 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1251 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1253 size_t i;
1254 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1255 return true;
1256 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1257 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1258 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1259 return true;
1262 return false;
1265 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1267 static rtx
1268 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1270 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1271 size_t i;
1272 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1274 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1275 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1276 return q->reg;
1278 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1279 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1280 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1281 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1283 return NULL_RTX;
1287 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1288 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1289 value, not an offset. */
1290 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1292 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1293 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1294 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1295 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1297 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1298 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1299 users need not read the source code.
1301 The High-Level Picture
1303 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1304 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1305 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1306 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1307 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1309 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1310 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1311 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1312 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1313 saves. This also seems to work.
1315 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1316 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1317 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1318 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1319 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1320 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1321 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1322 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1323 value as in the caller.
1325 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1326 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1327 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1328 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1330 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1331 register,
1333 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1335 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1336 consists of a register and an offset.
1337 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1338 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1339 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1340 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1341 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1342 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1343 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1345 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1346 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1347 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1348 cfa_temp.offset.
1350 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1351 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1352 and cfa_temp.offset.
1354 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1355 stack.
1357 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1358 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1359 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1361 The Rules
1363 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1364 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1366 Rule 1:
1367 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1368 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1369 cfa.offset unchanged
1370 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1371 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1373 Rule 2:
1374 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1375 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1376 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1377 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1378 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1379 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1381 Rule 3:
1382 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1383 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1384 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1386 Rule 4:
1387 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1388 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1389 <reg1> != sp
1390 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1391 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1392 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1394 Rule 5:
1395 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1396 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1397 <reg1> != sp
1398 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1399 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1401 Rule 6:
1402 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1403 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1404 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1406 Rule 7:
1407 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1408 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1409 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1411 Rule 8:
1412 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1413 effects: none
1415 Rule 9:
1416 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1417 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1418 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1420 Rule 10:
1421 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1422 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1423 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1424 cfa.reg = sp
1425 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1427 Rule 11:
1428 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1429 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1430 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1431 cfa.reg = sp
1432 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1434 Rule 12:
1435 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1437 <reg2>)
1438 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1439 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1441 Rule 13:
1442 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1443 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1444 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1446 Rule 14:
1447 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1448 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1449 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1450 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1452   Rule 15:
1453   (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1454   effects: target-dependent */
1456 static void
1457 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1459 rtx src, dest;
1460 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1462 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1463 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1464 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1465 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1466 flag is set in them. */
1467 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1469 int par_index;
1470 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1472 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1473 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1474 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1475 || par_index == 0))
1476 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1478 return;
1481 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1483 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1484 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1486 if (REG_P (src))
1488 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1489 if (rsi)
1490 src = rsi;
1493 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1495 case REG:
1496 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1498 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1499 case REG:
1500 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1502 /* Rule 1 */
1503 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1504 relative to the current CFA register.
1506 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1507 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1508 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1509 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1510 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1511 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1512 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1514 else
1516 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1517 gcc_assert (call_used_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1518 && (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1519 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1520 || DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1521 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1522 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1524 break;
1526 case PLUS:
1527 case MINUS:
1528 case LO_SUM:
1529 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1531 /* Rule 2 */
1532 /* Adjusting SP. */
1533 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1535 case CONST_INT:
1536 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1537 break;
1538 case REG:
1539 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1540 == cfa_temp.reg);
1541 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1542 break;
1543 default:
1544 gcc_unreachable ();
1547 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1549 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1550 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1551 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1553 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1554 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1556 else
1557 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1559 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1560 offset = -offset;
1561 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1562 cfa.offset += offset;
1563 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1564 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1566 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1568 /* Rule 3 */
1569 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1570 or adjusting the FP */
1571 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1573 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1574 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1575 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1576 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1577 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1578 offset = -offset;
1579 cfa.offset += offset;
1580 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1582 else
1584 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1586 /* Rule 4 */
1587 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1588 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1589 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1591 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1592 into the FP later on. */
1593 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1594 cfa.offset += offset;
1595 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1596 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1597 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1598 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1601 /* Rule 5 */
1602 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1603 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1604 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1606 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1607 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1608 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1609 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1610 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1613 /* Rule 9 */
1614 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1615 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1617 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1618 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1620 else
1621 gcc_unreachable ();
1623 break;
1625 /* Rule 6 */
1626 case CONST_INT:
1627 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1628 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1629 break;
1631 /* Rule 7 */
1632 case IOR:
1633 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1634 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1635 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1637 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1638 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1639 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1640 break;
1642 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1643 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1644 /* Rule 8 */
1645 case HIGH:
1646 break;
1648 /* Rule 15 */
1649 case UNSPEC:
1650 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1651 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1652 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1653 break;
1655 default:
1656 gcc_unreachable ();
1659 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1660 break;
1662 case MEM:
1663 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1665 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1666 CFA register. */
1667 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1669 /* Rule 10 */
1670 /* With a push. */
1671 case PRE_MODIFY:
1672 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1673 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1674 == CONST_INT);
1675 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1677 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1678 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1680 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1681 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1682 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1684 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1685 break;
1687 /* Rule 11 */
1688 case PRE_INC:
1689 case PRE_DEC:
1690 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1691 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1692 offset = -offset;
1694 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1695 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1697 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1698 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1699 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1701 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1702 break;
1704 /* Rule 12 */
1705 /* With an offset. */
1706 case PLUS:
1707 case MINUS:
1708 case LO_SUM:
1710 int regno;
1712 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT);
1713 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1714 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1715 offset = -offset;
1717 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1719 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1720 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1721 else
1723 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1724 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1727 break;
1729 /* Rule 13 */
1730 /* Without an offset. */
1731 case REG:
1733 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1735 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1736 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1737 else
1739 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1740 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1743 break;
1745 /* Rule 14 */
1746 case POST_INC:
1747 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1748 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1749 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1750 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1751 break;
1753 default:
1754 gcc_unreachable ();
1757 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1758 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1759 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1761 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1763 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1765 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1766 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1767 on the ARM. */
1768 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1769 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1770 break;
1772 else
1774 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1775 calculate the CFA. */
1776 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1778 if (!REG_P (x))
1779 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1780 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1782 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1783 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1784 cfa.indirect = 1;
1785 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1786 break;
1790 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1791 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1792 break;
1794 default:
1795 gcc_unreachable ();
1799 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1800 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1801 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1803 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1804 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1806 void
1807 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1809 const char *label;
1810 rtx src;
1812 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1814 size_t i;
1816 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1817 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1819 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1820 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1821 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1822 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1824 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1825 cfa_store = cfa;
1826 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1827 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1829 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1831 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1832 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1834 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1835 return;
1838 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1839 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1841 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1843 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1844 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1845 return;
1848 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1849 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1850 if (src)
1851 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1852 else
1853 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1855 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1858 #endif
1860 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1861 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1862 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1864 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1865 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1867 switch (cfi)
1869 case DW_CFA_nop:
1870 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1871 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1873 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1874 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1875 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1876 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1877 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1878 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1880 case DW_CFA_offset:
1881 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1882 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1883 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1884 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1885 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1886 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1887 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1888 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1889 case DW_CFA_register:
1890 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1892 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1893 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1894 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1895 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1897 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1898 case DW_CFA_expression:
1899 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1901 default:
1902 gcc_unreachable ();
1906 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1907 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1908 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1910 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1911 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1913 switch (cfi)
1915 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1916 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1917 case DW_CFA_offset:
1918 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1919 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1920 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1922 case DW_CFA_register:
1923 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1925 default:
1926 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1930 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1932 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
1933 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
1934 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
1935 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
1936 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
1937 #endif
1939 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
1941 static void
1942 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
1944 unsigned long r;
1945 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
1946 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1947 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
1948 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
1949 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
1950 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
1952 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
1953 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
1954 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
1955 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1957 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
1959 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
1960 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
1961 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
1963 else
1965 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
1966 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
1968 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
1970 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1971 if (for_eh)
1972 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
1973 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
1974 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
1975 NULL);
1976 else
1977 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
1978 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
1979 break;
1981 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1982 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1983 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1984 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1985 break;
1987 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1988 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1989 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1990 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1991 break;
1993 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1994 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1995 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1996 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1997 break;
1999 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2000 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2001 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2002 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2003 break;
2005 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2006 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2007 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2009 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2010 break;
2012 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2013 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2014 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2015 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2016 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2017 break;
2019 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2020 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2021 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2022 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2023 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2024 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2025 break;
2027 case DW_CFA_register:
2028 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2029 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2030 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2031 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2032 break;
2034 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2035 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2036 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2037 break;
2039 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2040 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2041 break;
2043 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2044 break;
2046 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2047 case DW_CFA_expression:
2048 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2049 break;
2051 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2052 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2053 gcc_unreachable ();
2055 default:
2056 break;
2061 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2062 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2063 location of saved registers. */
2065 static void
2066 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2068 unsigned int i;
2069 dw_fde_ref fde;
2070 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2071 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2072 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2073 char augmentation[6];
2074 int augmentation_size;
2075 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2076 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2077 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2078 int return_reg;
2080 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2081 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2082 return;
2084 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2085 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2086 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2087 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2088 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2089 specialization doesn't. */
2090 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2091 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2092 && for_eh)
2093 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2094 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2095 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2096 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2097 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2098 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2100 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2101 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2102 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2103 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2104 if (for_eh)
2106 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2108 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2109 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2110 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2111 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2112 any_eh_needed = true;
2113 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2114 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2115 any_eh_needed = true;
2117 if (! any_eh_needed)
2118 return;
2121 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2122 if (flag_debug_asm)
2123 app_enable ();
2125 if (for_eh)
2126 targetm.asm_out.eh_frame_section ();
2127 else
2128 named_section_flags (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
2130 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2131 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2133 /* Output the CIE. */
2134 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2135 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2136 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2137 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2138 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2140 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2141 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2142 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2143 (for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
2144 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2146 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2148 augmentation[0] = 0;
2149 augmentation_size = 0;
2150 if (for_eh)
2152 char *p;
2154 /* Augmentation:
2155 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2156 augmentation section.
2157 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2158 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2159 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2160 FDE code pointers.
2161 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2162 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2164 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2165 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2166 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2168 p = augmentation + 1;
2169 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2171 *p++ = 'P';
2172 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2174 if (any_lsda_needed)
2176 *p++ = 'L';
2177 augmentation_size += 1;
2179 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2181 *p++ = 'R';
2182 augmentation_size += 1;
2184 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2186 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2187 *p = '\0';
2190 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2191 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2193 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2194 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2195 + 1 /* CIE version */
2196 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2197 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2198 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2199 + 1 /* RA column */
2200 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2201 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2202 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2204 augmentation_size += pad;
2206 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2207 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2208 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2212 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2213 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2214 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2215 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2217 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2218 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2219 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2220 else
2221 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2223 if (augmentation[0])
2225 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2226 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2228 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2229 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2230 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2231 eh_personality_libfunc, NULL);
2234 if (any_lsda_needed)
2235 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2236 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2238 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2239 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2240 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2243 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2244 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2246 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2247 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2248 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2249 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2251 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2252 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2254 fde = &fde_table[i];
2256 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2257 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2258 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2259 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2260 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2261 continue;
2263 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2264 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2265 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2266 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2267 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2268 "FDE Length");
2269 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2271 if (for_eh)
2272 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2273 else
2274 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2275 "FDE CIE offset");
2277 if (for_eh)
2279 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2280 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2281 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2282 sym_ref,
2283 "FDE initial location");
2284 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2286 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2287 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2288 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2289 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2290 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2291 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2292 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3,
2293 "FDE initial location");
2294 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2295 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2296 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2297 "FDE address range");
2298 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2,
2299 "FDE initial location");
2300 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2301 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2302 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2303 "FDE address range");
2305 else
2306 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2307 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2308 "FDE address range");
2310 else
2312 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2313 "FDE initial location");
2314 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2316 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2317 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2318 "FDE initial location");
2319 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2320 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2321 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2322 "FDE address range");
2323 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2324 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2325 "FDE initial location");
2326 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2327 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2328 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2329 "FDE address range");
2331 else
2332 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2333 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2334 "FDE address range");
2337 if (augmentation[0])
2339 if (any_lsda_needed)
2341 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2343 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2345 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2346 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2347 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2348 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2349 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2351 size += pad;
2352 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2355 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2357 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2359 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2360 fde->funcdef_number);
2361 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2362 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2363 "Language Specific Data Area");
2365 else
2367 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2368 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2369 dw2_asm_output_data
2370 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2371 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2374 else
2375 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2378 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2379 this FDE. */
2380 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2381 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2382 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2384 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2385 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2386 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2387 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2390 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2391 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2392 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2393 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2394 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2395 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2396 #endif
2398 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2399 if (flag_debug_asm)
2400 app_disable ();
2403 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2404 the prologue. */
2406 void
2407 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2408 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2410 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2411 char * dup_label;
2412 dw_fde_ref fde;
2414 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2416 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2417 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2418 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2419 be used. */
2420 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2421 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2422 return;
2423 #else
2424 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2425 return;
2426 #endif
2428 function_section (current_function_decl);
2429 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2430 current_function_funcdef_no);
2431 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2432 current_function_funcdef_no);
2433 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2434 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2436 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2437 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2438 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2439 return;
2440 #endif
2442 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2443 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2445 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2446 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2447 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2448 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2449 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2452 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2453 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2455 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2456 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2457 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2458 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2459 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2460 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2461 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2462 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2463 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2464 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2465 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2466 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2467 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2468 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2469 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2470 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2472 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2474 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2475 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2476 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2477 if (file)
2478 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2479 #endif
2482 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2483 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2484 been generated. */
2486 void
2487 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2488 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2490 dw_fde_ref fde;
2491 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2493 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2494 function. */
2495 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2496 current_function_funcdef_no);
2497 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2498 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2499 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2502 void
2503 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2505 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2506 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2507 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2508 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2510 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2511 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2513 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2514 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2515 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2516 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2517 #endif
2520 void
2521 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2523 /* Output call frame information. */
2524 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
2525 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
2526 #ifdef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
2527 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
2528 #endif
2530 output_call_frame_info (0);
2532 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2533 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2534 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2535 output_call_frame_info (1);
2536 #endif
2538 #endif
2540 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2541 for emitting location expressions. */
2543 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2544 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2545 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2548 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2549 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2550 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2551 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2553 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2554 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2555 implementation are listed below. */
2557 enum dw_val_class
2559 dw_val_class_addr,
2560 dw_val_class_offset,
2561 dw_val_class_loc,
2562 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2563 dw_val_class_range_list,
2564 dw_val_class_const,
2565 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2566 dw_val_class_long_long,
2567 dw_val_class_vec,
2568 dw_val_class_flag,
2569 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2570 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2571 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2572 dw_val_class_lbl_offset,
2573 dw_val_class_str
2576 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2577 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2579 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2581 unsigned long hi;
2582 unsigned long low;
2584 dw_long_long_const;
2586 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2588 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2590 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2591 unsigned length;
2592 unsigned elt_size;
2594 dw_vec_const;
2596 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2597 represented internally. */
2599 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2601 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2602 union dw_val_struct_union
2604 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2605 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2606 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2607 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2608 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2609 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2610 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2611 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2612 struct dw_val_die_union
2614 dw_die_ref die;
2615 int external;
2616 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2617 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2618 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2619 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2620 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2622 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2624 dw_val_node;
2626 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2627 operations. */
2629 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2631 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2632 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2633 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2634 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2635 int dw_loc_addr;
2637 dw_loc_descr_node;
2639 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2640 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2641 their entire life. */
2642 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2644 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2645 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2646 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2647 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2648 Only on head of list */
2649 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2650 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2651 } dw_loc_list_node;
2653 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2655 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2656 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2657 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2658 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2659 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2660 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2661 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2662 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2664 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2666 static const char *
2667 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2669 switch (op)
2671 case DW_OP_addr:
2672 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2673 return "DW_OP_addr";
2674 case DW_OP_deref:
2675 return "DW_OP_deref";
2676 case DW_OP_const1u:
2677 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2678 case DW_OP_const1s:
2679 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2680 case DW_OP_const2u:
2681 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2682 case DW_OP_const2s:
2683 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2684 case DW_OP_const4u:
2685 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2686 case DW_OP_const4s:
2687 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2688 case DW_OP_const8u:
2689 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2690 case DW_OP_const8s:
2691 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2692 case DW_OP_constu:
2693 return "DW_OP_constu";
2694 case DW_OP_consts:
2695 return "DW_OP_consts";
2696 case DW_OP_dup:
2697 return "DW_OP_dup";
2698 case DW_OP_drop:
2699 return "DW_OP_drop";
2700 case DW_OP_over:
2701 return "DW_OP_over";
2702 case DW_OP_pick:
2703 return "DW_OP_pick";
2704 case DW_OP_swap:
2705 return "DW_OP_swap";
2706 case DW_OP_rot:
2707 return "DW_OP_rot";
2708 case DW_OP_xderef:
2709 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2710 case DW_OP_abs:
2711 return "DW_OP_abs";
2712 case DW_OP_and:
2713 return "DW_OP_and";
2714 case DW_OP_div:
2715 return "DW_OP_div";
2716 case DW_OP_minus:
2717 return "DW_OP_minus";
2718 case DW_OP_mod:
2719 return "DW_OP_mod";
2720 case DW_OP_mul:
2721 return "DW_OP_mul";
2722 case DW_OP_neg:
2723 return "DW_OP_neg";
2724 case DW_OP_not:
2725 return "DW_OP_not";
2726 case DW_OP_or:
2727 return "DW_OP_or";
2728 case DW_OP_plus:
2729 return "DW_OP_plus";
2730 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2731 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2732 case DW_OP_shl:
2733 return "DW_OP_shl";
2734 case DW_OP_shr:
2735 return "DW_OP_shr";
2736 case DW_OP_shra:
2737 return "DW_OP_shra";
2738 case DW_OP_xor:
2739 return "DW_OP_xor";
2740 case DW_OP_bra:
2741 return "DW_OP_bra";
2742 case DW_OP_eq:
2743 return "DW_OP_eq";
2744 case DW_OP_ge:
2745 return "DW_OP_ge";
2746 case DW_OP_gt:
2747 return "DW_OP_gt";
2748 case DW_OP_le:
2749 return "DW_OP_le";
2750 case DW_OP_lt:
2751 return "DW_OP_lt";
2752 case DW_OP_ne:
2753 return "DW_OP_ne";
2754 case DW_OP_skip:
2755 return "DW_OP_skip";
2756 case DW_OP_lit0:
2757 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2758 case DW_OP_lit1:
2759 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2760 case DW_OP_lit2:
2761 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2762 case DW_OP_lit3:
2763 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2764 case DW_OP_lit4:
2765 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2766 case DW_OP_lit5:
2767 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2768 case DW_OP_lit6:
2769 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2770 case DW_OP_lit7:
2771 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2772 case DW_OP_lit8:
2773 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2774 case DW_OP_lit9:
2775 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2776 case DW_OP_lit10:
2777 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2778 case DW_OP_lit11:
2779 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2780 case DW_OP_lit12:
2781 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2782 case DW_OP_lit13:
2783 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2784 case DW_OP_lit14:
2785 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2786 case DW_OP_lit15:
2787 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2788 case DW_OP_lit16:
2789 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2790 case DW_OP_lit17:
2791 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2792 case DW_OP_lit18:
2793 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2794 case DW_OP_lit19:
2795 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2796 case DW_OP_lit20:
2797 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2798 case DW_OP_lit21:
2799 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2800 case DW_OP_lit22:
2801 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2802 case DW_OP_lit23:
2803 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2804 case DW_OP_lit24:
2805 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2806 case DW_OP_lit25:
2807 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2808 case DW_OP_lit26:
2809 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2810 case DW_OP_lit27:
2811 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2812 case DW_OP_lit28:
2813 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2814 case DW_OP_lit29:
2815 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2816 case DW_OP_lit30:
2817 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2818 case DW_OP_lit31:
2819 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2820 case DW_OP_reg0:
2821 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2822 case DW_OP_reg1:
2823 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2824 case DW_OP_reg2:
2825 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2826 case DW_OP_reg3:
2827 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2828 case DW_OP_reg4:
2829 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2830 case DW_OP_reg5:
2831 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2832 case DW_OP_reg6:
2833 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2834 case DW_OP_reg7:
2835 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2836 case DW_OP_reg8:
2837 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2838 case DW_OP_reg9:
2839 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2840 case DW_OP_reg10:
2841 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2842 case DW_OP_reg11:
2843 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2844 case DW_OP_reg12:
2845 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2846 case DW_OP_reg13:
2847 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2848 case DW_OP_reg14:
2849 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2850 case DW_OP_reg15:
2851 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2852 case DW_OP_reg16:
2853 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2854 case DW_OP_reg17:
2855 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2856 case DW_OP_reg18:
2857 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2858 case DW_OP_reg19:
2859 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2860 case DW_OP_reg20:
2861 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2862 case DW_OP_reg21:
2863 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2864 case DW_OP_reg22:
2865 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2866 case DW_OP_reg23:
2867 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2868 case DW_OP_reg24:
2869 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2870 case DW_OP_reg25:
2871 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2872 case DW_OP_reg26:
2873 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2874 case DW_OP_reg27:
2875 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2876 case DW_OP_reg28:
2877 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2878 case DW_OP_reg29:
2879 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2880 case DW_OP_reg30:
2881 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2882 case DW_OP_reg31:
2883 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2884 case DW_OP_breg0:
2885 return "DW_OP_breg0";
2886 case DW_OP_breg1:
2887 return "DW_OP_breg1";
2888 case DW_OP_breg2:
2889 return "DW_OP_breg2";
2890 case DW_OP_breg3:
2891 return "DW_OP_breg3";
2892 case DW_OP_breg4:
2893 return "DW_OP_breg4";
2894 case DW_OP_breg5:
2895 return "DW_OP_breg5";
2896 case DW_OP_breg6:
2897 return "DW_OP_breg6";
2898 case DW_OP_breg7:
2899 return "DW_OP_breg7";
2900 case DW_OP_breg8:
2901 return "DW_OP_breg8";
2902 case DW_OP_breg9:
2903 return "DW_OP_breg9";
2904 case DW_OP_breg10:
2905 return "DW_OP_breg10";
2906 case DW_OP_breg11:
2907 return "DW_OP_breg11";
2908 case DW_OP_breg12:
2909 return "DW_OP_breg12";
2910 case DW_OP_breg13:
2911 return "DW_OP_breg13";
2912 case DW_OP_breg14:
2913 return "DW_OP_breg14";
2914 case DW_OP_breg15:
2915 return "DW_OP_breg15";
2916 case DW_OP_breg16:
2917 return "DW_OP_breg16";
2918 case DW_OP_breg17:
2919 return "DW_OP_breg17";
2920 case DW_OP_breg18:
2921 return "DW_OP_breg18";
2922 case DW_OP_breg19:
2923 return "DW_OP_breg19";
2924 case DW_OP_breg20:
2925 return "DW_OP_breg20";
2926 case DW_OP_breg21:
2927 return "DW_OP_breg21";
2928 case DW_OP_breg22:
2929 return "DW_OP_breg22";
2930 case DW_OP_breg23:
2931 return "DW_OP_breg23";
2932 case DW_OP_breg24:
2933 return "DW_OP_breg24";
2934 case DW_OP_breg25:
2935 return "DW_OP_breg25";
2936 case DW_OP_breg26:
2937 return "DW_OP_breg26";
2938 case DW_OP_breg27:
2939 return "DW_OP_breg27";
2940 case DW_OP_breg28:
2941 return "DW_OP_breg28";
2942 case DW_OP_breg29:
2943 return "DW_OP_breg29";
2944 case DW_OP_breg30:
2945 return "DW_OP_breg30";
2946 case DW_OP_breg31:
2947 return "DW_OP_breg31";
2948 case DW_OP_regx:
2949 return "DW_OP_regx";
2950 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2951 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
2952 case DW_OP_bregx:
2953 return "DW_OP_bregx";
2954 case DW_OP_piece:
2955 return "DW_OP_piece";
2956 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2957 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
2958 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2959 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
2960 case DW_OP_nop:
2961 return "DW_OP_nop";
2962 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
2963 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
2964 case DW_OP_call2:
2965 return "DW_OP_call2";
2966 case DW_OP_call4:
2967 return "DW_OP_call4";
2968 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2969 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
2970 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
2971 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
2972 default:
2973 return "OP_<unknown>";
2977 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
2978 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
2979 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
2981 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
2982 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
2983 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
2985 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
2987 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
2988 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2989 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
2990 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2991 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
2993 return descr;
2997 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
2999 static inline void
3000 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3002 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3004 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3005 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3008 *d = descr;
3011 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3013 static unsigned long
3014 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3016 unsigned long size = 1;
3018 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3020 case DW_OP_addr:
3021 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3022 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3023 break;
3024 case DW_OP_const1u:
3025 case DW_OP_const1s:
3026 size += 1;
3027 break;
3028 case DW_OP_const2u:
3029 case DW_OP_const2s:
3030 size += 2;
3031 break;
3032 case DW_OP_const4u:
3033 case DW_OP_const4s:
3034 size += 4;
3035 break;
3036 case DW_OP_const8u:
3037 case DW_OP_const8s:
3038 size += 8;
3039 break;
3040 case DW_OP_constu:
3041 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3042 break;
3043 case DW_OP_consts:
3044 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3045 break;
3046 case DW_OP_pick:
3047 size += 1;
3048 break;
3049 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3050 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3051 break;
3052 case DW_OP_skip:
3053 case DW_OP_bra:
3054 size += 2;
3055 break;
3056 case DW_OP_breg0:
3057 case DW_OP_breg1:
3058 case DW_OP_breg2:
3059 case DW_OP_breg3:
3060 case DW_OP_breg4:
3061 case DW_OP_breg5:
3062 case DW_OP_breg6:
3063 case DW_OP_breg7:
3064 case DW_OP_breg8:
3065 case DW_OP_breg9:
3066 case DW_OP_breg10:
3067 case DW_OP_breg11:
3068 case DW_OP_breg12:
3069 case DW_OP_breg13:
3070 case DW_OP_breg14:
3071 case DW_OP_breg15:
3072 case DW_OP_breg16:
3073 case DW_OP_breg17:
3074 case DW_OP_breg18:
3075 case DW_OP_breg19:
3076 case DW_OP_breg20:
3077 case DW_OP_breg21:
3078 case DW_OP_breg22:
3079 case DW_OP_breg23:
3080 case DW_OP_breg24:
3081 case DW_OP_breg25:
3082 case DW_OP_breg26:
3083 case DW_OP_breg27:
3084 case DW_OP_breg28:
3085 case DW_OP_breg29:
3086 case DW_OP_breg30:
3087 case DW_OP_breg31:
3088 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3089 break;
3090 case DW_OP_regx:
3091 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3092 break;
3093 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3094 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3095 break;
3096 case DW_OP_bregx:
3097 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3098 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3099 break;
3100 case DW_OP_piece:
3101 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3102 break;
3103 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3104 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3105 size += 1;
3106 break;
3107 case DW_OP_call2:
3108 size += 2;
3109 break;
3110 case DW_OP_call4:
3111 size += 4;
3112 break;
3113 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3114 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3115 break;
3116 default:
3117 break;
3120 return size;
3123 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3125 static unsigned long
3126 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3128 unsigned long size;
3130 for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3132 loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
3133 size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
3136 return size;
3139 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3141 static void
3142 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3144 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3145 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3147 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3149 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3150 case DW_OP_addr:
3151 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3152 break;
3153 case DW_OP_const2u:
3154 case DW_OP_const2s:
3155 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3156 break;
3157 case DW_OP_const4u:
3158 case DW_OP_const4s:
3159 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3160 break;
3161 case DW_OP_const8u:
3162 case DW_OP_const8s:
3163 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3164 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3165 break;
3166 case DW_OP_skip:
3167 case DW_OP_bra:
3169 int offset;
3171 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3172 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3174 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3176 break;
3177 #else
3178 case DW_OP_addr:
3179 case DW_OP_const2u:
3180 case DW_OP_const2s:
3181 case DW_OP_const4u:
3182 case DW_OP_const4s:
3183 case DW_OP_const8u:
3184 case DW_OP_const8s:
3185 case DW_OP_skip:
3186 case DW_OP_bra:
3187 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3188 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3189 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3190 only doing unwinding. */
3191 gcc_unreachable ();
3192 #endif
3193 case DW_OP_const1u:
3194 case DW_OP_const1s:
3195 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3196 break;
3197 case DW_OP_constu:
3198 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3199 break;
3200 case DW_OP_consts:
3201 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3202 break;
3203 case DW_OP_pick:
3204 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3205 break;
3206 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3207 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3208 break;
3209 case DW_OP_breg0:
3210 case DW_OP_breg1:
3211 case DW_OP_breg2:
3212 case DW_OP_breg3:
3213 case DW_OP_breg4:
3214 case DW_OP_breg5:
3215 case DW_OP_breg6:
3216 case DW_OP_breg7:
3217 case DW_OP_breg8:
3218 case DW_OP_breg9:
3219 case DW_OP_breg10:
3220 case DW_OP_breg11:
3221 case DW_OP_breg12:
3222 case DW_OP_breg13:
3223 case DW_OP_breg14:
3224 case DW_OP_breg15:
3225 case DW_OP_breg16:
3226 case DW_OP_breg17:
3227 case DW_OP_breg18:
3228 case DW_OP_breg19:
3229 case DW_OP_breg20:
3230 case DW_OP_breg21:
3231 case DW_OP_breg22:
3232 case DW_OP_breg23:
3233 case DW_OP_breg24:
3234 case DW_OP_breg25:
3235 case DW_OP_breg26:
3236 case DW_OP_breg27:
3237 case DW_OP_breg28:
3238 case DW_OP_breg29:
3239 case DW_OP_breg30:
3240 case DW_OP_breg31:
3241 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3242 break;
3243 case DW_OP_regx:
3244 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3245 break;
3246 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3247 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3248 break;
3249 case DW_OP_bregx:
3250 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3251 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3252 break;
3253 case DW_OP_piece:
3254 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3255 break;
3256 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3257 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3258 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3259 break;
3261 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3262 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
3263 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (asm_out_file, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3264 val1->v.val_addr);
3265 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3266 #else
3267 gcc_unreachable ();
3268 #endif
3269 break;
3271 default:
3272 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3273 break;
3277 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3279 static void
3280 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3282 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3284 /* Output the opcode. */
3285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3286 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3288 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3289 output_loc_operands (loc);
3293 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3294 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3296 static void
3297 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3299 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3300 unsigned long size;
3302 /* Output the size of the block. */
3303 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3304 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3305 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3307 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3308 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3311 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from
3312 a dw_cfa_location. */
3314 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3315 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa)
3317 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3319 gcc_assert (cfa->indirect);
3321 if (cfa->base_offset)
3323 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3324 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3325 else
3326 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3328 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3329 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3330 else
3331 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3333 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3334 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3335 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3336 if (cfa->offset != 0)
3338 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, cfa->offset, 0);
3339 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3342 return head;
3345 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3346 descriptor sequence. */
3348 static void
3349 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3351 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3352 cfa->offset = 0;
3353 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3354 cfa->indirect = 0;
3355 cfa->reg = -1;
3357 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3359 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3361 switch (op)
3363 case DW_OP_reg0:
3364 case DW_OP_reg1:
3365 case DW_OP_reg2:
3366 case DW_OP_reg3:
3367 case DW_OP_reg4:
3368 case DW_OP_reg5:
3369 case DW_OP_reg6:
3370 case DW_OP_reg7:
3371 case DW_OP_reg8:
3372 case DW_OP_reg9:
3373 case DW_OP_reg10:
3374 case DW_OP_reg11:
3375 case DW_OP_reg12:
3376 case DW_OP_reg13:
3377 case DW_OP_reg14:
3378 case DW_OP_reg15:
3379 case DW_OP_reg16:
3380 case DW_OP_reg17:
3381 case DW_OP_reg18:
3382 case DW_OP_reg19:
3383 case DW_OP_reg20:
3384 case DW_OP_reg21:
3385 case DW_OP_reg22:
3386 case DW_OP_reg23:
3387 case DW_OP_reg24:
3388 case DW_OP_reg25:
3389 case DW_OP_reg26:
3390 case DW_OP_reg27:
3391 case DW_OP_reg28:
3392 case DW_OP_reg29:
3393 case DW_OP_reg30:
3394 case DW_OP_reg31:
3395 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3396 break;
3397 case DW_OP_regx:
3398 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3399 break;
3400 case DW_OP_breg0:
3401 case DW_OP_breg1:
3402 case DW_OP_breg2:
3403 case DW_OP_breg3:
3404 case DW_OP_breg4:
3405 case DW_OP_breg5:
3406 case DW_OP_breg6:
3407 case DW_OP_breg7:
3408 case DW_OP_breg8:
3409 case DW_OP_breg9:
3410 case DW_OP_breg10:
3411 case DW_OP_breg11:
3412 case DW_OP_breg12:
3413 case DW_OP_breg13:
3414 case DW_OP_breg14:
3415 case DW_OP_breg15:
3416 case DW_OP_breg16:
3417 case DW_OP_breg17:
3418 case DW_OP_breg18:
3419 case DW_OP_breg19:
3420 case DW_OP_breg20:
3421 case DW_OP_breg21:
3422 case DW_OP_breg22:
3423 case DW_OP_breg23:
3424 case DW_OP_breg24:
3425 case DW_OP_breg25:
3426 case DW_OP_breg26:
3427 case DW_OP_breg27:
3428 case DW_OP_breg28:
3429 case DW_OP_breg29:
3430 case DW_OP_breg30:
3431 case DW_OP_breg31:
3432 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3433 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3434 break;
3435 case DW_OP_bregx:
3436 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3437 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3438 break;
3439 case DW_OP_deref:
3440 cfa->indirect = 1;
3441 break;
3442 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3443 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3444 break;
3445 default:
3446 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented\n",
3447 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3451 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3453 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3454 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3456 /* .debug_str support. */
3457 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3459 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3460 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3461 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3462 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3463 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3464 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3465 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3466 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3467 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3468 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3469 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3470 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3471 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3472 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3473 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3474 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3476 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3478 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3480 dwarf2out_init,
3481 dwarf2out_finish,
3482 dwarf2out_define,
3483 dwarf2out_undef,
3484 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3485 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3486 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3487 dwarf2out_end_block,
3488 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3489 dwarf2out_source_line,
3490 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3491 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3492 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3493 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3494 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3495 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3496 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3497 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3498 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3499 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3500 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3501 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3502 something tries to reference them. */
3503 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3504 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3505 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3506 dwarf2out_var_location,
3507 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3508 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3510 #endif
3512 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3513 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3514 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3516 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3517 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3518 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3519 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3521 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3522 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3524 typedef long int dw_offset;
3526 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3528 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3529 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3530 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3531 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3532 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3534 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3535 line number associated with the label generated for that
3536 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3537 the line number entry. */
3539 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3541 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3542 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3544 dw_line_info_entry;
3546 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3547 own sequence. */
3548 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3550 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3551 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3552 unsigned long function;
3554 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3556 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3557 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3558 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3560 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3562 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3563 dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
3564 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3566 dw_attr_node;
3568 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
3570 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3572 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3573 char *die_symbol;
3574 dw_attr_ref die_attr;
3575 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3576 dw_die_ref die_child;
3577 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3578 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3579 dw_offset die_offset;
3580 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3581 int die_mark;
3582 unsigned int decl_id;
3584 die_node;
3586 /* The pubname structure */
3588 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3590 dw_die_ref die;
3591 char *name;
3593 pubname_entry;
3595 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3597 int block_num;
3600 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3601 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3603 dw_die_ref die;
3604 tree created_for;
3605 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3607 limbo_die_node;
3609 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3610 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3611 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3612 #endif
3614 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3615 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3617 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3618 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3619 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3620 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3621 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3622 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3624 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3625 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3626 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3627 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3628 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3629 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3630 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3631 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3632 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3633 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3635 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3636 language, and compiler version. */
3638 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3639 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3640 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3642 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3643 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3645 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3646 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3647 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3648 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3649 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3651 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3652 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3653 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3654 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3655 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3656 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3658 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3659 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3660 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3661 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3662 #else
3663 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3664 #endif
3665 #endif
3667 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3668 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3669 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3671 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3672 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3674 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3675 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3677 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3678 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3679 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3680 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3681 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3683 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3684 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3685 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3686 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3687 #endif
3689 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3690 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3692 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3693 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3695 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3696 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table;
3697 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table_emitted;
3698 static GTY(()) size_t file_table_last_lookup_index;
3700 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3701 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3702 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3704 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3705 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3707 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3708 const char * GTY (()) label;
3709 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3710 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3713 /* Variable location list. */
3714 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3716 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3718 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3719 it is marked through the chain. */
3720 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3722 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3723 unsigned int decl_id;
3725 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3728 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3729 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3731 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3732 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3733 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3734 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3735 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3737 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3738 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3740 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3741 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3743 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3744 abbrev_die_table. */
3745 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3747 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3748 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3749 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3750 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3752 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3753 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3755 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3756 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3758 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3759 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3760 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3761 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3763 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3764 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3766 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3767 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3769 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3770 line_info_table. */
3771 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3773 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3774 accessible names. */
3775 static GTY ((length ("pubname_table_allocated"))) pubname_ref pubname_table;
3777 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3778 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3780 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3781 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3783 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3784 pubname_table. */
3785 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3787 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3788 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3790 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3791 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3793 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3794 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3796 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3797 arange_table. */
3798 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3800 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3801 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3803 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3804 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3806 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3807 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3809 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3810 ranges_table. */
3811 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3813 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3814 static GTY(()) unsigned have_location_lists;
3816 /* Unique label counter. */
3817 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3819 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3820 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3821 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3822 #endif
3823 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3824 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3825 #endif
3827 /* Number of file tables emitted in maybe_emit_file(). */
3828 static GTY(()) int emitcount = 0;
3830 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3831 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3833 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3835 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3837 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
3838 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3839 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
3840 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3841 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3842 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3843 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
3844 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
3845 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3846 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
3847 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
3848 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3849 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
3850 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3851 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
3852 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3853 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
3854 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
3855 unsigned long);
3856 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3857 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3858 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
3859 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
3860 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3861 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
3862 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
3863 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3864 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3865 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
3866 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
3867 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
3868 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3869 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3870 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
3871 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3872 dw_loc_list_ref);
3873 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
3874 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
3875 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
3876 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3877 static void add_AT_lbl_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3878 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3879 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3880 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3881 unsigned long);
3882 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
3883 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3884 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3885 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3886 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3887 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3888 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3889 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3890 static bool is_c_family (void);
3891 static bool is_cxx (void);
3892 static bool is_java (void);
3893 static bool is_fortran (void);
3894 static bool is_ada (void);
3895 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3896 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3897 static inline void free_die (dw_die_ref);
3898 static void remove_children (dw_die_ref);
3899 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3900 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3901 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3902 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3903 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
3904 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
3905 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3906 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
3907 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
3908 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
3909 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3910 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
3911 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3912 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3913 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
3914 static void reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref);
3915 static void reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3916 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3917 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
3918 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3919 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3920 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3921 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3922 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
3923 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
3924 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3925 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3926 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
3927 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3928 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3929 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
3930 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
3931 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
3932 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
3933 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
3934 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
3935 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
3936 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
3937 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3938 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
3939 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3940 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
3941 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3942 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3943 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3944 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3945 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3946 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (void);
3947 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3948 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3949 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3950 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3951 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
3952 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3953 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
3954 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
3955 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3956 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3957 static void output_pubnames (void);
3958 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
3959 static void output_aranges (void);
3960 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
3961 static void output_ranges (void);
3962 static void output_line_info (void);
3963 static void output_file_names (void);
3964 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
3965 static tree root_type (tree);
3966 static int is_base_type (tree);
3967 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
3968 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3969 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
3970 static int type_is_enum (tree);
3971 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
3972 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
3973 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
3974 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
3975 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
3976 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT, bool);
3977 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
3978 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode, bool);
3979 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
3980 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, bool);
3981 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
3982 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
3983 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3984 static tree field_type (tree);
3985 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
3986 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
3987 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
3988 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
3989 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3990 dw_loc_descr_ref);
3991 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3992 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3993 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3994 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
3995 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
3996 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3997 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3998 enum dwarf_attribute);
3999 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4000 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4001 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4002 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4003 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4004 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4005 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4006 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4007 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4008 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4009 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4010 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4011 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4012 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4013 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4014 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4015 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4016 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4017 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4018 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4019 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4020 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4021 #if 0
4022 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4023 #endif
4024 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4025 #if 0
4026 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4027 #endif
4028 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4029 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4030 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4031 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4032 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4033 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4034 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4035 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4036 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4037 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4038 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4039 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4040 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4041 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4042 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4043 static void gen_string_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4044 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4045 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4046 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4047 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4048 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4049 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4050 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4051 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4052 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4053 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4054 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4055 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4056 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4057 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4058 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4059 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4060 static unsigned lookup_filename (const char *);
4061 static void init_file_table (void);
4062 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4063 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4064 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4065 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4066 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4067 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4068 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4069 const char *, const char *,
4070 const char *);
4071 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4072 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4074 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4075 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4076 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4077 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4078 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4079 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4080 static int maybe_emit_file (int);
4082 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4083 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4084 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4085 #endif
4086 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4087 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4088 #endif
4089 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4090 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4091 #endif
4092 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4093 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4094 #endif
4095 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4096 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4097 #endif
4098 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4099 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4100 #endif
4101 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4102 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4103 #endif
4104 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4105 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4106 #endif
4107 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4108 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4109 #endif
4111 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4112 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4113 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4114 #endif
4116 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4117 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4118 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
4119 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4120 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4122 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4123 the section names themselves. */
4125 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4126 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4127 #endif
4128 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4129 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4130 #endif
4131 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4132 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4133 #endif
4134 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4135 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4136 #endif
4137 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4138 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4139 #endif
4140 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4141 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4142 #endif
4143 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4144 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4145 #endif
4146 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4147 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4148 #endif
4150 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4151 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4152 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4153 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4154 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4156 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4157 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4158 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4159 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4160 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4161 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4162 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4163 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4164 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4165 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4167 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4168 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4169 #endif
4170 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4171 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4172 #endif
4173 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4174 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4175 #endif
4176 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4177 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4178 #endif
4179 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4180 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4181 #endif
4182 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4183 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4184 #endif
4186 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4187 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4189 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4191 void
4192 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4194 demangle_name_func = func;
4197 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4199 static inline int
4200 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4202 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4203 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4204 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4207 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4208 removed. */
4210 static inline tree
4211 type_main_variant (tree type)
4213 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4215 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4216 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4217 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4218 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4219 here. */
4220 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4221 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4222 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4224 return type;
4227 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4229 static inline int
4230 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4232 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4234 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4235 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4238 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4240 static const char *
4241 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4243 switch (tag)
4245 case DW_TAG_padding:
4246 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4247 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4248 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4249 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4250 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4251 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4252 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4253 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4254 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4255 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4256 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4257 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4258 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4259 case DW_TAG_label:
4260 return "DW_TAG_label";
4261 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4262 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4263 case DW_TAG_member:
4264 return "DW_TAG_member";
4265 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4266 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4267 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4268 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4269 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4270 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4271 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4272 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4273 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4274 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4275 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4276 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4277 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4278 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4279 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4280 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4281 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4282 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4283 case DW_TAG_variant:
4284 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4285 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4286 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4287 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4288 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4289 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4290 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4291 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4292 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4293 case DW_TAG_module:
4294 return "DW_TAG_module";
4295 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4296 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4297 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4298 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4299 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4300 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4301 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4302 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4303 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4304 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4305 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4306 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4307 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4308 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4309 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4310 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4311 case DW_TAG_constant:
4312 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4313 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4314 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4315 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4316 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4317 case DW_TAG_friend:
4318 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4319 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4320 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4321 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4322 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4323 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4324 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4325 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4326 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4327 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4328 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4329 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4330 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4331 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4332 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4333 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4334 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4335 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4336 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4337 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4338 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4339 case DW_TAG_variable:
4340 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4341 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4342 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4343 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4344 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4345 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4346 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4347 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4348 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4349 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4350 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4351 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4352 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4353 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4354 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4355 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4356 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4357 default:
4358 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4362 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4364 static const char *
4365 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4367 switch (attr)
4369 case DW_AT_sibling:
4370 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4371 case DW_AT_location:
4372 return "DW_AT_location";
4373 case DW_AT_name:
4374 return "DW_AT_name";
4375 case DW_AT_ordering:
4376 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4377 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4378 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4379 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4380 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4381 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4382 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4383 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4384 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4385 case DW_AT_element_list:
4386 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4387 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4388 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4389 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4390 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4391 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4392 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4393 case DW_AT_language:
4394 return "DW_AT_language";
4395 case DW_AT_member:
4396 return "DW_AT_member";
4397 case DW_AT_discr:
4398 return "DW_AT_discr";
4399 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4400 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4401 case DW_AT_visibility:
4402 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4403 case DW_AT_import:
4404 return "DW_AT_import";
4405 case DW_AT_string_length:
4406 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4407 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4408 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4409 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4410 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4411 case DW_AT_const_value:
4412 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4413 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4414 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4415 case DW_AT_default_value:
4416 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4417 case DW_AT_inline:
4418 return "DW_AT_inline";
4419 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4420 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4421 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4422 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4423 case DW_AT_producer:
4424 return "DW_AT_producer";
4425 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4426 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4427 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4428 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4429 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4430 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4431 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4432 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4433 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4434 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4435 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4436 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4437 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4438 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4439 case DW_AT_address_class:
4440 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4441 case DW_AT_artificial:
4442 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4443 case DW_AT_base_types:
4444 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4445 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4446 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4447 case DW_AT_count:
4448 return "DW_AT_count";
4449 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4450 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4451 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4452 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4453 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4454 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4455 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4456 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4457 case DW_AT_declaration:
4458 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4459 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4460 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4461 case DW_AT_encoding:
4462 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4463 case DW_AT_external:
4464 return "DW_AT_external";
4465 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4466 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4467 case DW_AT_friend:
4468 return "DW_AT_friend";
4469 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4470 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4471 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4472 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4473 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4474 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4475 case DW_AT_priority:
4476 return "DW_AT_priority";
4477 case DW_AT_segment:
4478 return "DW_AT_segment";
4479 case DW_AT_specification:
4480 return "DW_AT_specification";
4481 case DW_AT_static_link:
4482 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4483 case DW_AT_type:
4484 return "DW_AT_type";
4485 case DW_AT_use_location:
4486 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4487 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4488 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4489 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4490 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4491 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4492 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4494 case DW_AT_allocated:
4495 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4496 case DW_AT_associated:
4497 return "DW_AT_associated";
4498 case DW_AT_data_location:
4499 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4500 case DW_AT_stride:
4501 return "DW_AT_stride";
4502 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4503 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4504 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4505 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4506 case DW_AT_extension:
4507 return "DW_AT_extension";
4508 case DW_AT_ranges:
4509 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4510 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4511 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4512 case DW_AT_call_column:
4513 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4514 case DW_AT_call_file:
4515 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4516 case DW_AT_call_line:
4517 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4519 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4520 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4521 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4522 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4523 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4524 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4525 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4526 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4527 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4528 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4529 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4530 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4531 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4532 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4533 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4534 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4535 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4536 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4537 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4538 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4539 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4540 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4542 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4543 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4544 case DW_AT_src_info:
4545 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4546 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4547 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4548 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4549 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4550 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4551 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4552 case DW_AT_body_end:
4553 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4554 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4555 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4557 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4558 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4560 default:
4561 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4565 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4567 static const char *
4568 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4570 switch (form)
4572 case DW_FORM_addr:
4573 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4574 case DW_FORM_block2:
4575 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4576 case DW_FORM_block4:
4577 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4578 case DW_FORM_data2:
4579 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4580 case DW_FORM_data4:
4581 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4582 case DW_FORM_data8:
4583 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4584 case DW_FORM_string:
4585 return "DW_FORM_string";
4586 case DW_FORM_block:
4587 return "DW_FORM_block";
4588 case DW_FORM_block1:
4589 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4590 case DW_FORM_data1:
4591 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4592 case DW_FORM_flag:
4593 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4594 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4595 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4596 case DW_FORM_strp:
4597 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4598 case DW_FORM_udata:
4599 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4600 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4601 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4602 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4603 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4604 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4605 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4606 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4607 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4608 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4609 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4610 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4611 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4612 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4613 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4614 default:
4615 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4619 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4620 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4621 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4622 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4623 given block. */
4625 static tree
4626 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4628 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4629 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4630 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4631 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4632 return NULL_TREE;
4634 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4635 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4636 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4638 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4641 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4642 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4643 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4644 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4645 given block. */
4647 static tree
4648 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4650 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4652 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4653 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4654 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4655 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4656 return NULL_TREE;
4658 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4659 return NULL_TREE;
4660 else
4662 tree ret_val;
4663 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4667 ret_val = lookahead;
4668 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4669 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4671 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4673 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4674 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4675 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4676 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4677 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4678 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
4679 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4680 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4682 return ret_val;
4686 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4687 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4688 parameter. */
4690 static tree
4691 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4693 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4695 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4696 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4697 else
4698 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4699 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4701 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4702 context = NULL_TREE;
4704 return context;
4707 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
4708 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
4710 static inline void
4711 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4713 if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
4715 attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
4716 die->die_attr = attr;
4720 static inline enum dw_val_class
4721 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4723 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4726 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4728 static inline void
4729 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4731 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4733 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4734 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4735 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4736 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4737 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4740 static inline unsigned
4741 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4743 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4744 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4747 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4749 static inline void
4750 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4752 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4754 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4755 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4756 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4757 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4758 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4761 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4762 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4764 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4765 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4768 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4770 static inline void
4771 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4772 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4774 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4776 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4777 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4778 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4779 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4780 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4783 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4784 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4786 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4787 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4790 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4792 static inline void
4793 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4794 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4796 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4798 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4799 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4800 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4801 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4802 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4803 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4806 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4808 static inline void
4809 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4810 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4812 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4814 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4815 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4816 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4817 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4818 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4819 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4820 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4823 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4825 static hashval_t
4826 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
4828 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
4831 static int
4832 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
4834 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
4835 (const char *)x2) == 0;
4838 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4840 static inline void
4841 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4843 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4844 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4845 void **slot;
4847 if (! debug_str_hash)
4848 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
4849 debug_str_eq, NULL);
4851 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
4852 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4853 if (*slot == NULL)
4854 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
4855 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
4856 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4857 node->refcount++;
4859 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4860 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4861 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4862 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4863 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4866 static inline const char *
4867 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
4869 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4870 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4873 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4874 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4876 static int
4877 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
4879 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4880 unsigned int len;
4881 char label[32];
4883 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4885 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
4886 if (node->form)
4887 return node->form;
4889 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4891 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4892 always better to put it inline. */
4893 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4894 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4896 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4897 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4898 single module. */
4899 if ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4900 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
4901 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4903 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4904 ++dw2_string_counter;
4905 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4907 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4910 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4912 static inline void
4913 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4915 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4917 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4918 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4919 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4920 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4921 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4922 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4925 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4926 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4928 static inline void
4929 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4931 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4932 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4933 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4936 static inline dw_die_ref
4937 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
4939 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4940 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4943 static inline int
4944 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
4946 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4947 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4949 return 0;
4952 static inline void
4953 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
4955 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4956 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4959 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4961 static inline void
4962 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4964 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4966 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4967 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4968 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4969 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4970 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4973 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4975 static inline void
4976 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4978 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4980 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4981 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4982 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4983 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4984 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4987 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4988 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
4990 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4991 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4994 static inline void
4995 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4997 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4999 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5000 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5001 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5002 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5003 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5004 have_location_lists = 1;
5007 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5008 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5010 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5011 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5014 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5016 static inline void
5017 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5019 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5021 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5022 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5023 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5024 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5025 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5028 static inline rtx
5029 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5031 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5032 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5035 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5037 static inline void
5038 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5040 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5042 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5043 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5044 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5045 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5046 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5049 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5051 static inline void
5052 add_AT_lbl_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *label)
5054 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5056 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5057 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5058 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_offset;
5059 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5060 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5063 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5065 static inline void
5066 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5067 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5069 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5071 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5072 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5073 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5074 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5075 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5078 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5080 static void
5081 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5082 long unsigned int offset)
5084 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
5086 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
5087 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
5088 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5089 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5090 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
5093 static inline const char *
5094 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5096 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5097 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_offset));
5098 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5101 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5103 static dw_attr_ref
5104 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5106 dw_attr_ref a;
5107 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5109 if (die != NULL)
5111 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5112 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5113 return a;
5114 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5115 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5116 spec = AT_ref (a);
5118 if (spec)
5119 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5122 return NULL;
5125 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5126 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5127 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5129 static inline const char *
5130 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5132 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5134 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5137 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5138 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5139 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5141 static inline const char *
5142 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5144 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5146 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5149 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5150 NULL if it is not present. */
5152 static inline const char *
5153 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5155 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5157 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5160 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5161 if it is not present. */
5163 static inline int
5164 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5166 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5168 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5171 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5172 if it is not present. */
5174 static inline unsigned
5175 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5177 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5179 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5182 static inline dw_die_ref
5183 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5185 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5187 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5190 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5192 static inline bool
5193 is_c_family (void)
5195 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5197 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
5198 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
5201 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5203 static inline bool
5204 is_cxx (void)
5206 return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
5207 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
5210 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5212 static inline bool
5213 is_fortran (void)
5215 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5217 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5218 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5219 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5222 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5224 static inline bool
5225 is_java (void)
5227 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5229 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5232 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5234 static inline bool
5235 is_ada (void)
5237 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5239 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5242 /* Free up the memory used by A. */
5244 static inline void free_AT (dw_attr_ref);
5245 static inline void
5246 free_AT (dw_attr_ref a)
5248 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5249 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5250 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5253 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5255 static void
5256 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5258 dw_attr_ref *p;
5259 dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
5261 if (die != NULL)
5263 for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
5264 if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5266 removed = *p;
5267 *p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
5268 break;
5271 if (removed != 0)
5272 free_AT (removed);
5276 /* Remove child die whose die_tag is specified tag. */
5278 static void
5279 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5281 dw_die_ref current, prev, next;
5282 current = die->die_child;
5283 prev = NULL;
5284 while (current != NULL)
5286 if (current->die_tag == tag)
5288 next = current->die_sib;
5289 if (prev == NULL)
5290 die->die_child = next;
5291 else
5292 prev->die_sib = next;
5293 free_die (current);
5294 current = next;
5296 else
5298 prev = current;
5299 current = current->die_sib;
5304 /* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
5306 static inline void
5307 free_die (dw_die_ref die)
5309 remove_children (die);
5312 /* Discard the children of this DIE. */
5314 static void
5315 remove_children (dw_die_ref die)
5317 dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
5319 die->die_child = NULL;
5321 while (child_die != NULL)
5323 dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
5324 dw_attr_ref a;
5326 child_die = child_die->die_sib;
5328 for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
5330 dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
5332 a = a->dw_attr_next;
5333 free_AT (tmp_a);
5336 free_die (tmp_die);
5340 /* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
5341 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
5343 static inline void
5344 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5346 if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
5348 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5350 child_die->die_parent = die;
5351 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
5352 die->die_child = child_die;
5356 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5357 is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
5359 static void
5360 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5362 dw_die_ref *p;
5364 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5365 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5366 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5368 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5370 if (tmp)
5371 child = tmp;
5374 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5375 || (child->die_parent
5376 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5378 for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
5379 if (*p == child)
5381 *p = child->die_sib;
5382 break;
5385 child->die_parent = parent;
5386 child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
5387 parent->die_child = child;
5390 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5392 static inline dw_die_ref
5393 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5395 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5397 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5399 if (parent_die != NULL)
5400 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5401 else
5403 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5405 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5406 limbo_node->die = die;
5407 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5408 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5409 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5412 return die;
5415 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5417 static inline dw_die_ref
5418 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5420 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5423 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5425 static inline void
5426 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5428 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5431 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5433 static hashval_t
5434 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5436 return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5439 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5441 static int
5442 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5444 return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5447 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5449 static inline dw_die_ref
5450 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5452 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5455 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5457 static hashval_t
5458 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5460 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5463 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5464 UID of decl *Y. */
5466 static int
5467 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5469 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5472 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5474 static inline var_loc_list *
5475 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5477 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5480 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5482 static void
5483 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5485 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5486 void **slot;
5488 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5489 *slot = decl_die;
5490 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5493 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5495 static void
5496 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5498 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5499 var_loc_list *temp;
5500 void **slot;
5502 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5503 if (*slot == NULL)
5505 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5506 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5507 *slot = temp;
5509 else
5510 temp = *slot;
5512 if (temp->last)
5514 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5515 we have nothing to do. */
5516 if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5517 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5519 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5520 temp->last->next = loc;
5521 temp->last = loc;
5524 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5525 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5527 temp->first = loc;
5528 temp->last = loc;
5532 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5533 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5534 the DIE internal representation. */
5535 static int print_indent;
5537 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5539 static inline void
5540 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5542 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5545 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5546 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5548 static void
5549 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5551 dw_attr_ref a;
5552 dw_die_ref c;
5554 print_spaces (outfile);
5555 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5556 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5557 print_spaces (outfile);
5558 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5559 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5561 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5563 print_spaces (outfile);
5564 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5566 switch (AT_class (a))
5568 case dw_val_class_addr:
5569 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5570 break;
5571 case dw_val_class_offset:
5572 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5573 break;
5574 case dw_val_class_loc:
5575 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5576 break;
5577 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5578 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5579 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5580 break;
5581 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5582 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5583 break;
5584 case dw_val_class_const:
5585 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5586 break;
5587 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5588 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5589 break;
5590 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5591 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5592 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5593 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5594 break;
5595 case dw_val_class_vec:
5596 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5597 break;
5598 case dw_val_class_flag:
5599 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5600 break;
5601 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5602 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5604 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5605 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5606 else
5607 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5609 else
5610 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5611 break;
5612 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5613 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5614 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5615 break;
5616 case dw_val_class_str:
5617 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5618 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5619 else
5620 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5621 break;
5622 default:
5623 break;
5626 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5629 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5631 print_indent += 4;
5632 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5633 print_die (c, outfile);
5635 print_indent -= 4;
5637 if (print_indent == 0)
5638 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5641 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5642 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5644 static void
5645 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5647 unsigned i;
5648 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5650 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5651 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5653 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5654 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5655 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s",
5656 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, line_info->dw_file_num));
5657 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5658 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5661 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5664 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5666 void
5667 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5669 print_die (die, stderr);
5672 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5673 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5675 void
5676 debug_dwarf (void)
5678 print_indent = 0;
5679 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5680 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5681 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5684 /* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
5685 onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
5686 they are in order of addition. */
5688 static void
5689 reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref die)
5691 dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
5692 dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
5694 for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
5696 an = a->dw_attr_next;
5697 a->dw_attr_next = ap;
5698 ap = a;
5701 die->die_attr = ap;
5703 for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
5705 cn = c->die_sib;
5706 c->die_sib = cp;
5707 cp = c;
5710 die->die_child = cp;
5713 /* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
5714 reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
5715 it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
5716 reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
5717 recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
5719 static void
5720 reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
5722 dw_die_ref c;
5724 reverse_die_lists (die);
5726 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5727 reverse_all_dies (c);
5730 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5731 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5732 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5734 static dw_die_ref
5735 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5737 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5738 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5740 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5741 return new_unit;
5744 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5746 static dw_die_ref
5747 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5749 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5751 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5752 return new_unit;
5755 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5756 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5758 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5760 static inline void
5761 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5763 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5764 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5765 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5768 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5770 static void
5771 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5773 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5774 rtx r;
5776 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5778 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5779 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5780 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5781 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5782 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5783 return;
5785 switch (AT_class (at))
5787 case dw_val_class_const:
5788 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5789 break;
5790 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5791 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5792 break;
5793 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5794 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5795 break;
5796 case dw_val_class_vec:
5797 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5798 break;
5799 case dw_val_class_flag:
5800 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5801 break;
5802 case dw_val_class_str:
5803 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5804 break;
5806 case dw_val_class_addr:
5807 r = AT_addr (at);
5808 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5809 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5810 break;
5812 case dw_val_class_offset:
5813 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5814 break;
5816 case dw_val_class_loc:
5817 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5818 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5819 break;
5821 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5822 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5823 break;
5825 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5826 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5827 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5828 break;
5830 default:
5831 break;
5835 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5837 static void
5838 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5840 dw_die_ref c;
5841 dw_attr_ref a;
5843 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5844 if (die->die_mark)
5846 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5847 return;
5849 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5851 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5853 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5854 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5856 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5857 die_checksum (c, ctx, mark);
5860 #undef CHECKSUM
5861 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5863 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
5864 static inline int
5865 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
5867 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
5868 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
5869 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
5872 /* Do the values look the same? */
5873 static int
5874 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
5876 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
5877 rtx r1, r2;
5879 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
5880 return 0;
5882 switch (v1->val_class)
5884 case dw_val_class_const:
5885 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
5886 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5887 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
5888 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5889 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
5890 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
5891 case dw_val_class_vec:
5892 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
5893 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
5894 return 0;
5895 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
5896 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
5897 return 0;
5898 return 1;
5899 case dw_val_class_flag:
5900 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
5901 case dw_val_class_str:
5902 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
5904 case dw_val_class_addr:
5905 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
5906 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
5907 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
5908 return 0;
5909 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
5910 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
5912 case dw_val_class_offset:
5913 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
5915 case dw_val_class_loc:
5916 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
5917 loc1 && loc2;
5918 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
5919 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
5920 return 0;
5921 return !loc1 && !loc2;
5923 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5924 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
5926 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5927 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5928 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5929 return 1;
5931 default:
5932 return 1;
5936 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
5938 static int
5939 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
5941 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
5942 return 0;
5944 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5945 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5946 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5947 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5948 || at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5949 return 1;
5951 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
5954 /* Do the dies look the same? */
5956 static int
5957 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
5959 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
5960 dw_attr_ref a1, a2;
5962 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5963 if (die1->die_mark)
5964 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
5965 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5967 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
5968 return 0;
5970 for (a1 = die1->die_attr, a2 = die2->die_attr;
5971 a1 && a2;
5972 a1 = a1->dw_attr_next, a2 = a2->dw_attr_next)
5973 if (!same_attr_p (a1, a2, mark))
5974 return 0;
5975 if (a1 || a2)
5976 return 0;
5978 for (c1 = die1->die_child, c2 = die2->die_child;
5979 c1 && c2;
5980 c1 = c1->die_sib, c2 = c2->die_sib)
5981 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
5982 return 0;
5983 if (c1 || c2)
5984 return 0;
5986 return 1;
5989 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
5991 static int
5992 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
5994 int mark = 0;
5995 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
5997 unmark_all_dies (die1);
5998 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6000 return ret;
6003 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6004 info section. */
6005 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6007 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6008 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6010 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6011 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6013 static void
6014 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6016 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6017 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6018 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6019 char *p;
6020 int i, mark;
6021 unsigned char checksum[16];
6022 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6024 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6025 the name filename of the unit. */
6027 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6028 mark = 0;
6029 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6030 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6031 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6033 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6034 clean_symbol_name (name);
6036 p = name + strlen (name);
6037 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6039 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6040 p += 2;
6043 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6044 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6047 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6049 static int
6050 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6052 switch (die->die_tag)
6054 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6055 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6056 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6057 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6058 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6059 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6060 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6061 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6062 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6063 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6064 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6065 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6066 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6067 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6068 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6069 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6070 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6071 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6072 return 1;
6073 default:
6074 return 0;
6078 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6079 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6080 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6081 compilations (functions). */
6083 static int
6084 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6086 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6087 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6088 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6089 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6091 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6092 return 0;
6094 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6095 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6096 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6097 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6099 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6101 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6104 return is_type_die (c);
6107 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6108 compilation unit. */
6110 static int
6111 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6113 return (is_type_die (c)
6114 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6115 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
6118 static char *
6119 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6121 char buf[256];
6123 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6124 return xstrdup (buf);
6127 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6129 static void
6130 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6132 dw_die_ref c;
6134 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6136 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6138 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6140 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6141 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6142 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6144 else
6145 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6148 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6149 assign_symbol_names (c);
6152 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6154 dw_die_ref cu;
6155 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6156 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6159 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6160 static hashval_t
6161 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6163 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6165 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6168 static int
6169 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6171 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6172 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6174 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6177 static void
6178 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6180 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6182 while (entry)
6184 next = entry->next;
6185 free (entry);
6186 entry = next;
6190 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6191 accordingly. */
6192 static int
6193 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6195 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6196 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6198 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6200 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6201 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6202 INSERT);
6203 entry = *slot;
6205 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6207 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6208 break;
6211 if (entry)
6213 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6214 return 1;
6217 entry = xcalloc (1, sizeof (struct cu_hash_table_entry));
6218 entry->cu = cu;
6219 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6220 entry->next = *slot;
6221 *slot = entry;
6223 return 0;
6226 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6227 static void
6228 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6230 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6232 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6233 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6234 NO_INSERT);
6235 entry = *slot;
6237 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6240 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6241 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6242 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6244 static void
6245 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6247 dw_die_ref *ptr;
6248 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6249 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6250 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6252 for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr;)
6254 dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
6256 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6257 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6259 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6260 *ptr = c->die_sib;
6262 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6264 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6265 free_die (c);
6267 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6269 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6270 free_die (c);
6272 else
6273 add_child_die (unit, c);
6275 else
6277 /* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
6278 ptr = &(c->die_sib);
6279 continue;
6283 #if 0
6284 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6285 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6286 gcc_assert (!unit);
6287 #endif
6289 assign_symbol_names (die);
6290 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6291 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6292 node;
6293 node = node->next)
6295 int is_dupl;
6297 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6298 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6299 &comdat_symbol_number);
6300 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6301 if (is_dupl)
6302 *pnode = node->next;
6303 else
6305 pnode = &node->next;
6306 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6307 comdat_symbol_number);
6310 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6313 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6314 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6315 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6317 static void
6318 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6320 dw_die_ref c;
6322 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
6323 && die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
6324 /* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
6325 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6327 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6328 add_sibling_attributes (c);
6331 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6333 static void
6334 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6336 dw_die_ref c;
6337 dw_attr_ref d_attr;
6339 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6340 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6341 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
6343 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6344 output_location_lists (c);
6348 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6349 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6350 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6351 die are visited recursively. */
6353 static void
6354 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6356 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6357 unsigned int n_alloc;
6358 dw_die_ref c;
6359 dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
6361 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6362 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6363 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6364 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6365 && AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
6367 gcc_assert (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol);
6369 set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
6372 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6374 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6376 if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
6378 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
6380 a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
6381 d_attr = die->die_attr;
6383 while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
6385 if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
6386 || (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
6387 break;
6389 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
6390 d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
6393 if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
6394 break;
6399 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6401 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6403 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6404 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6405 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6407 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6408 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6409 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6412 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6413 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6416 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6417 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6418 build_abbrev_table (c);
6421 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6423 static int
6424 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6426 int log;
6428 if (value == 0)
6429 log = 0;
6430 else
6431 log = floor_log2 (value);
6433 log = log / 8;
6434 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6436 return log;
6439 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6440 .debug_info section. */
6442 static unsigned long
6443 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6445 unsigned long size = 0;
6446 dw_attr_ref a;
6448 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6449 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6451 switch (AT_class (a))
6453 case dw_val_class_addr:
6454 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6455 break;
6456 case dw_val_class_offset:
6457 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6458 break;
6459 case dw_val_class_loc:
6461 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6463 /* Block length. */
6464 size += constant_size (lsize);
6465 size += lsize;
6467 break;
6468 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6469 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6470 break;
6471 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6472 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6473 break;
6474 case dw_val_class_const:
6475 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6476 break;
6477 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6478 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6479 break;
6480 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6481 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6482 break;
6483 case dw_val_class_vec:
6484 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6485 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6486 break;
6487 case dw_val_class_flag:
6488 size += 1;
6489 break;
6490 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6491 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6492 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6493 else
6494 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6495 break;
6496 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6497 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6498 break;
6499 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6500 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6501 break;
6502 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6503 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6504 break;
6505 case dw_val_class_str:
6506 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6507 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6508 else
6509 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6510 break;
6511 default:
6512 gcc_unreachable ();
6516 return size;
6519 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6520 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6521 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6522 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6524 static void
6525 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6527 dw_die_ref c;
6529 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6530 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6532 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6533 calc_die_sizes (c);
6535 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6536 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6537 next_die_offset += 1;
6540 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6541 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6542 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6543 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6545 static void
6546 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6548 dw_die_ref c;
6550 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6552 die->die_mark = 1;
6553 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6554 mark_dies (c);
6557 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6559 static void
6560 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6562 dw_die_ref c;
6564 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6566 die->die_mark = 0;
6567 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6568 unmark_dies (c);
6571 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6573 static void
6574 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6576 dw_die_ref c;
6577 dw_attr_ref a;
6579 if (!die->die_mark)
6580 return;
6581 die->die_mark = 0;
6583 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6584 unmark_all_dies (c);
6586 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6587 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6588 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6591 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
6592 compilation unit. */
6594 static unsigned long
6595 size_of_pubnames (void)
6597 unsigned long size;
6598 unsigned i;
6600 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6601 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6603 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6604 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6607 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6608 return size;
6611 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6613 static unsigned long
6614 size_of_aranges (void)
6616 unsigned long size;
6618 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6620 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6621 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6622 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6624 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6625 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6626 return size;
6629 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6631 static enum dwarf_form
6632 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6634 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6636 case dw_val_class_addr:
6637 return DW_FORM_addr;
6638 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6639 case dw_val_class_offset:
6640 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6642 case 4:
6643 return DW_FORM_data4;
6644 case 8:
6645 return DW_FORM_data8;
6646 default:
6647 gcc_unreachable ();
6649 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6650 /* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
6651 .debug_loc section */
6652 return DW_FORM_data4;
6653 case dw_val_class_loc:
6654 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6656 case 1:
6657 return DW_FORM_block1;
6658 case 2:
6659 return DW_FORM_block2;
6660 default:
6661 gcc_unreachable ();
6663 case dw_val_class_const:
6664 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6665 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6666 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6668 case 1:
6669 return DW_FORM_data1;
6670 case 2:
6671 return DW_FORM_data2;
6672 case 4:
6673 return DW_FORM_data4;
6674 case 8:
6675 return DW_FORM_data8;
6676 default:
6677 gcc_unreachable ();
6679 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6680 return DW_FORM_block1;
6681 case dw_val_class_vec:
6682 return DW_FORM_block1;
6683 case dw_val_class_flag:
6684 return DW_FORM_flag;
6685 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6686 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6687 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6688 else
6689 return DW_FORM_ref;
6690 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6691 return DW_FORM_data;
6692 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6693 return DW_FORM_addr;
6694 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6695 return DW_FORM_data;
6696 case dw_val_class_str:
6697 return AT_string_form (a);
6699 default:
6700 gcc_unreachable ();
6704 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6706 static void
6707 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6709 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6711 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6714 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6715 table. */
6717 static void
6718 output_abbrev_section (void)
6720 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6722 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6724 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6726 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6728 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6729 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6730 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6732 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6733 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6734 else
6735 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6737 for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
6738 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
6740 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6741 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6742 output_value_format (a_attr);
6745 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6746 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6749 /* Terminate the table. */
6750 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6753 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6755 static inline void
6756 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6758 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6760 if (sym == 0)
6761 return;
6763 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6764 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6765 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6766 will break. */
6767 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6769 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6772 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6773 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6774 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6776 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6777 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6778 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6780 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6782 retlist->begin = begin;
6783 retlist->end = end;
6784 retlist->expr = expr;
6785 retlist->section = section;
6786 if (gensym)
6787 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6789 return retlist;
6792 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6794 static inline void
6795 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6796 const char *begin, const char *end,
6797 const char *section)
6799 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6801 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6802 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6805 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6806 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6809 static void
6810 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6812 dw_fde_ref fde;
6814 if (!cfun)
6815 internal_error ("Attempt to switch text sections without any code.");
6817 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6818 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6819 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6820 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6821 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6822 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6823 separate_line_info_table_in_use++;
6826 /* Output the location list given to us. */
6828 static void
6829 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
6831 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6833 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6835 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
6836 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
6838 unsigned long size;
6839 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
6841 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6842 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6843 list_head->ll_symbol);
6844 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6845 "Location list end address (%s)",
6846 list_head->ll_symbol);
6848 else
6850 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
6851 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6852 list_head->ll_symbol);
6853 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
6854 "Location list end address (%s)",
6855 list_head->ll_symbol);
6857 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6859 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6860 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
6861 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6863 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
6866 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
6867 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
6868 list_head->ll_symbol);
6869 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
6870 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
6871 list_head->ll_symbol);
6874 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
6875 the definitions of each child DIE. */
6877 static void
6878 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
6880 dw_attr_ref a;
6881 dw_die_ref c;
6882 unsigned long size;
6884 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
6885 them to point to. */
6886 if (die->die_symbol)
6887 output_die_symbol (die);
6889 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
6890 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
6892 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6894 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
6896 switch (AT_class (a))
6898 case dw_val_class_addr:
6899 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
6900 break;
6902 case dw_val_class_offset:
6903 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
6904 "%s", name);
6905 break;
6907 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6909 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
6911 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
6912 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6913 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
6914 "%s", name);
6915 *p = '\0';
6917 break;
6919 case dw_val_class_loc:
6920 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6922 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6923 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
6925 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
6926 break;
6928 case dw_val_class_const:
6929 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
6930 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
6931 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
6932 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
6933 break;
6935 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6936 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
6937 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
6938 break;
6940 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6942 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
6944 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
6945 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6946 "%s", name);
6948 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6950 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6951 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6953 else
6955 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6956 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6959 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6960 first, "long long constant");
6961 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6962 second, NULL);
6964 break;
6966 case dw_val_class_vec:
6968 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
6969 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
6970 unsigned int i;
6971 unsigned char *p;
6973 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
6974 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
6976 elt_size /= 2;
6977 len *= 2;
6979 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
6980 i < len;
6981 i++, p += elt_size)
6982 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
6983 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
6984 break;
6987 case dw_val_class_flag:
6988 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
6989 break;
6991 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6993 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
6995 gcc_assert (sym);
6996 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
6998 break;
7000 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7001 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7003 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7005 gcc_assert (sym);
7006 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
7008 else
7010 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7011 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7012 "%s", name);
7014 break;
7016 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7018 char l1[20];
7020 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7021 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7022 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, "%s", name);
7024 break;
7026 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7027 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7028 break;
7030 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
7031 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7032 break;
7034 case dw_val_class_str:
7035 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7036 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7037 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7038 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7039 else
7040 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7041 break;
7043 default:
7044 gcc_unreachable ();
7048 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
7049 output_die (c);
7051 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7052 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7053 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7054 die->die_offset);
7057 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7058 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7060 static void
7061 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7063 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7064 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7065 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7066 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7067 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7068 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7069 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7070 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7071 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7072 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7075 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7077 static void
7078 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7080 const char *secname;
7081 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7083 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7084 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7085 return;
7087 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7088 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7089 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7090 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7091 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7092 mark_dies (die);
7094 build_abbrev_table (die);
7096 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7097 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7098 calc_die_sizes (die);
7100 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7101 if (oldsym)
7103 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7105 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7106 secname = tmp;
7107 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7109 else
7110 secname = (const char *) DEBUG_INFO_SECTION;
7112 /* Output debugging information. */
7113 named_section_flags (secname, SECTION_DEBUG);
7114 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7115 output_die (die);
7117 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7118 output_pubnames. */
7119 if (oldsym)
7121 unmark_dies (die);
7122 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7126 /* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The
7127 output of lang_hooks.decl_printable_name for C++ looks like
7128 "A::f(int)". Let's drop the argument list, and maybe the scope. */
7130 static const char *
7131 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7133 return lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7136 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7138 static void
7139 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7141 pubname_ref p;
7143 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7144 return;
7146 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
7148 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7149 pubname_table
7150 = ggc_realloc (pubname_table,
7151 (pubname_table_allocated * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
7152 memset (pubname_table + pubname_table_in_use, 0,
7153 PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (pubname_entry));
7156 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
7157 p->die = die;
7158 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7161 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7162 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
7163 visible procedures. */
7165 static void
7166 output_pubnames (void)
7168 unsigned i;
7169 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
7171 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7172 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7173 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7174 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7175 "Length of Public Names Info");
7176 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7177 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7178 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7179 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7180 "Compilation Unit Length");
7182 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
7184 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
7186 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7187 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7189 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7190 "DIE offset");
7192 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7195 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7198 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7200 static void
7201 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7203 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7204 return;
7206 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7208 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7209 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7210 (arange_table_allocated
7211 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7212 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7213 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7216 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7219 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7220 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7221 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7223 static void
7224 output_aranges (void)
7226 unsigned i;
7227 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7229 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7230 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7231 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7232 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7233 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7234 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7235 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7236 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7237 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7238 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7240 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7241 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7243 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7244 pointer size. */
7245 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7246 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7247 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7248 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7251 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7252 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7253 text_section_label, "Length");
7254 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7256 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7257 "Address");
7258 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7259 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7262 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7264 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7266 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7267 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7269 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7271 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7272 "Address");
7273 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7274 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7276 else
7278 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7279 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7280 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7281 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7282 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7284 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7286 loc = AT_loc (a);
7287 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7289 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7290 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7291 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7292 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7293 "Length");
7297 /* Output the terminator words. */
7298 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7299 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7302 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7303 was placed. */
7305 static unsigned int
7306 add_ranges (tree block)
7308 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7310 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7312 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7313 ranges_table
7314 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7315 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7316 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7317 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7320 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7321 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7323 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7326 static void
7327 output_ranges (void)
7329 unsigned i;
7330 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7331 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7333 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7335 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7337 if (block_num)
7339 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7340 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7342 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7343 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7345 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7346 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7347 base of the text section. */
7348 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
7350 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7351 text_section_label,
7352 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7353 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7354 text_section_label, NULL);
7357 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7358 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7359 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7360 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
7361 else
7363 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7364 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7365 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7368 fmt = NULL;
7370 else
7372 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7373 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7374 fmt = start_fmt;
7379 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7380 struct file_info
7382 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7383 char *fname; /* File name part. */
7384 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7385 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7386 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7389 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7390 files. */
7391 struct dir_info
7393 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7394 int length; /* Path length. */
7395 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7396 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7397 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7398 int used; /* Used in the end? */
7401 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7402 the directories in the path. */
7404 static int
7405 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7407 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7408 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7409 unsigned char *cp1;
7410 unsigned char *cp2;
7412 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7413 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7414 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7415 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7416 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7417 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7418 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7420 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7421 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7423 while (1)
7425 ++cp1;
7426 ++cp2;
7427 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7428 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7429 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7430 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7431 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7433 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7434 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7435 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7439 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7440 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7441 slowdowns with many input files. */
7443 static void
7444 output_file_names (void)
7446 struct file_info *files;
7447 struct dir_info *dirs;
7448 int *saved;
7449 int *savehere;
7450 int *backmap;
7451 size_t ndirs;
7452 int idx_offset;
7453 size_t i;
7454 int idx;
7456 /* Handle the case where file_table is empty. */
7457 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) <= 1)
7459 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7460 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7461 return;
7464 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7465 files = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct file_info));
7466 dirs = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7468 /* Sort the file names. */
7469 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7471 char *f;
7473 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7474 f = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i);
7475 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7476 f += 2;
7478 /* Create a new array entry. */
7479 files[i].path = f;
7480 files[i].length = strlen (f);
7481 files[i].file_idx = i;
7483 /* Search for the file name part. */
7484 f = strrchr (f, '/');
7485 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
7488 qsort (files + 1, VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) - 1,
7489 sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7491 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7492 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
7493 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
7494 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7495 dirs[0].count = 1;
7496 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7497 dirs[0].used = 0;
7498 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
7499 ndirs = 1;
7501 for (i = 2; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7502 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7503 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7504 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7506 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7507 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7508 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7510 else
7512 size_t j;
7514 /* This is a new directory. */
7515 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7516 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7517 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7518 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7519 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
7520 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7522 /* Search for a prefix. */
7523 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7524 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7525 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7526 && dirs[j].length > 1
7527 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7528 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7529 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7530 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7532 ++ndirs;
7535 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7536 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7537 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7538 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7539 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7540 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7541 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7542 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7544 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7545 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7547 size_t j;
7548 int total;
7550 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7551 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7552 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7553 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7555 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7557 savehere[j] = 0;
7558 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7560 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7561 dirs[j] path. */
7562 int k;
7564 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7565 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7566 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7568 if (k == (int) i)
7570 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
7571 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7572 dirs[i]. */
7573 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7574 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7579 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7580 directory. */
7581 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7583 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7584 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7585 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7587 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7588 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7590 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7591 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7596 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
7597 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
7598 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7599 backmap = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (int));
7600 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7602 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
7604 /* Mark this directory as used. */
7605 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
7608 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
7609 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
7610 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
7611 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
7612 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
7613 idx = 1;
7614 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7615 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7616 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
7618 dirs[i].used = idx++;
7619 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7620 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
7623 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7625 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
7626 exists. */
7627 if (idx_offset == 0)
7628 dirs[0].used = 0;
7630 /* Now write all the file names. */
7631 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7633 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7634 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7636 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7637 "File Entry: 0x%lx", (unsigned long) i);
7639 /* Include directory index. */
7640 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
7642 /* Modification time. */
7643 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7645 /* File length in bytes. */
7646 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7649 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7653 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7654 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7656 static void
7657 output_line_info (void)
7659 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7660 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7661 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7662 unsigned opc;
7663 unsigned n_op_args;
7664 unsigned long lt_index;
7665 unsigned long current_line;
7666 long line_offset;
7667 long line_delta;
7668 unsigned long current_file;
7669 unsigned long function;
7671 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7672 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7673 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7674 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7676 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7677 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7678 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7679 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7680 "Length of Source Line Info");
7681 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7683 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7684 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7685 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7687 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7688 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7689 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7690 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7691 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7692 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7693 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7694 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7695 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7696 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7698 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7699 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7700 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7701 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7702 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7703 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7704 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7705 "Special Opcode Base");
7707 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7709 switch (opc)
7711 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7712 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7713 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7714 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7715 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7716 n_op_args = 1;
7717 break;
7718 default:
7719 n_op_args = 0;
7720 break;
7723 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7724 opc, n_op_args);
7727 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7728 output_file_names ();
7729 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7731 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7732 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7733 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7735 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7736 a series of state machine operations. */
7737 current_file = 1;
7738 current_line = 1;
7740 if (cfun
7741 && (last_text_section == in_unlikely_executed_text
7742 || (last_text_section == in_named
7743 && last_text_section_name == cfun->unlikely_text_section_name)))
7744 strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7745 else
7746 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7747 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7749 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7751 #if 0
7752 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7753 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7754 prologue. */
7756 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7757 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7758 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7759 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7760 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7761 continue;
7762 #endif
7764 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7766 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7767 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7768 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7769 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7770 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7771 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7773 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7774 if (0)
7776 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7777 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7778 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7779 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7781 else
7783 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7784 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7785 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7786 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7787 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7788 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7791 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7793 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7794 different from the previous line. */
7795 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7797 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7798 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7799 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7800 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7801 current_file));
7804 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7805 that uses the least amount of space. */
7806 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7808 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7809 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7810 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7811 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7812 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7813 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7814 takes 1 byte. */
7815 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7816 "line %lu", current_line);
7817 else
7819 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7820 depending on the value being encoded. */
7821 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7822 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7823 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7824 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7827 else
7828 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7829 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7832 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7833 if (0)
7835 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7836 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7837 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7839 else
7841 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7842 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7843 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7844 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7847 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7848 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7849 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7851 function = 0;
7852 current_file = 1;
7853 current_line = 1;
7854 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
7856 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
7857 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
7859 #if 0
7860 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
7861 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7862 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
7863 && line_info->function == function)
7864 goto cont;
7865 #endif
7867 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
7868 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
7869 to handle it differently. */
7870 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
7871 lt_index);
7872 if (function != line_info->function)
7874 function = line_info->function;
7876 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
7877 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7878 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7879 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7880 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7882 else
7884 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
7885 if (0)
7887 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7888 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7889 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7891 else
7893 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7894 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7895 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7896 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7900 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7902 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7903 different from the previous line. */
7904 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7906 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7907 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7909 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7910 current_file));
7913 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7914 that uses the least amount of space. */
7915 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7917 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7918 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7919 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7920 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7921 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7922 "line %lu", current_line);
7923 else
7925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7926 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7927 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7928 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7931 else
7932 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7934 #if 0
7935 cont:
7936 #endif
7938 lt_index++;
7940 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
7941 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
7942 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
7944 current_file = 1;
7945 current_line = 1;
7947 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7948 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
7949 if (0)
7951 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7952 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7953 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7955 else
7957 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7958 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7959 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7960 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7963 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
7964 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7965 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7966 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7970 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
7971 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
7974 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
7975 a DIE that describes the given type.
7977 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
7978 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
7980 static dw_die_ref
7981 base_type_die (tree type)
7983 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
7984 const char *type_name;
7985 enum dwarf_type encoding;
7986 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
7988 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
7989 return 0;
7991 if (name)
7993 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
7994 name = DECL_NAME (name);
7996 type_name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name);
7998 else
7999 type_name = "__unknown__";
8001 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8003 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8004 /* Carefully distinguish the C character types, without messing
8005 up if the language is not C. Note that we check only for the names
8006 that contain spaces; other names might occur by coincidence in other
8007 languages. */
8008 if (! (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
8009 && (type == char_type_node
8010 || ! strcmp (type_name, "signed char")
8011 || ! strcmp (type_name, "unsigned char"))))
8013 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8014 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8015 else
8016 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8017 break;
8019 /* else fall through. */
8021 case CHAR_TYPE:
8022 /* GNU Pascal/Ada CHAR type. Not used in C. */
8023 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8024 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8025 else
8026 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8027 break;
8029 case REAL_TYPE:
8030 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8031 break;
8033 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8034 a user defined type for it. */
8035 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8036 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8037 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8038 else
8039 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8040 break;
8042 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8043 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8044 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8045 break;
8047 default:
8048 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8049 gcc_unreachable ();
8052 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8053 if (demangle_name_func)
8054 type_name = (*demangle_name_func) (type_name);
8056 add_AT_string (base_type_result, DW_AT_name, type_name);
8057 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8058 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8059 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8061 return base_type_result;
8064 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8065 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
8066 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8067 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8068 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8069 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8070 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8071 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
8073 static tree
8074 root_type (tree type)
8076 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8077 return error_mark_node;
8079 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8081 case ERROR_MARK:
8082 return error_mark_node;
8084 case POINTER_TYPE:
8085 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8086 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8088 default:
8089 return type_main_variant (type);
8093 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8094 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8096 static inline int
8097 is_base_type (tree type)
8099 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8101 case ERROR_MARK:
8102 case VOID_TYPE:
8103 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8104 case REAL_TYPE:
8105 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8106 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8107 case CHAR_TYPE:
8108 return 1;
8110 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8111 case RECORD_TYPE:
8112 case UNION_TYPE:
8113 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8114 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8115 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8116 case METHOD_TYPE:
8117 case POINTER_TYPE:
8118 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8119 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8120 case LANG_TYPE:
8121 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8122 return 0;
8124 default:
8125 gcc_unreachable ();
8128 return 0;
8131 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8132 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8133 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8134 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8135 ERROR_MARK node. */
8137 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8138 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8140 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8141 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8142 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8143 return 0;
8144 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8145 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8146 else
8147 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8150 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8151 emitted as a subrange type. */
8153 static inline bool
8154 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8156 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8158 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8159 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8160 or an enumeral type. */
8162 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8163 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8164 return false;
8166 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8167 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8168 return false;
8170 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8171 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8172 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8173 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8174 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8175 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8176 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8177 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8179 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8180 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8181 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8182 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8183 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8184 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8185 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8186 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8187 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8188 keep checking the actual size. */
8189 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8190 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8192 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8193 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8195 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8196 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8198 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8199 return false;
8202 return true;
8205 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8206 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8208 static dw_die_ref
8209 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8211 dw_die_ref subtype_die;
8212 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8213 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8214 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8215 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8217 if (context_die == NULL)
8218 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8220 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8221 subtype_die = gen_enumeration_type_die (subtype, context_die);
8222 else
8223 subtype_die = base_type_die (subtype);
8225 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8227 if (name != NULL)
8229 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8230 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8231 add_name_attribute (subrange_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8234 if (int_size_in_bytes (subtype) != size_in_bytes)
8236 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8237 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8238 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8241 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8242 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8243 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8244 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8245 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8246 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8247 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, DW_AT_type, subtype_die);
8249 return subrange_die;
8252 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8253 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8255 static dw_die_ref
8256 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8257 dw_die_ref context_die)
8259 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8260 dw_die_ref mod_type_die = NULL;
8261 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8262 tree item_type = NULL;
8264 if (code != ERROR_MARK)
8266 tree qualified_type;
8268 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8269 this type. */
8270 qualified_type
8271 = get_qualified_type (type,
8272 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8273 | (is_volatile_type
8274 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8276 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8277 if (qualified_type)
8279 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8280 if (mod_type_die)
8281 return mod_type_die;
8284 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8285 if (qualified_type && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
8286 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL
8287 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
8289 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (qualified_type);
8290 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (type_name);
8292 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8294 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8295 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8296 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8298 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8299 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype))
8300 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8301 type to which it refers. */
8302 mod_type_die
8303 = modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (type_name),
8304 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8305 context_die);
8307 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8310 if (mod_type_die)
8311 /* OK. */
8313 else if (is_const_type)
8315 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8316 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8318 else if (is_volatile_type)
8320 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8321 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8323 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8325 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8326 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8327 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8328 #if 0
8329 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
8330 #endif
8331 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8333 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8335 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8336 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8337 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8338 #if 0
8339 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
8340 #endif
8341 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8343 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8344 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8345 else if (is_base_type (type))
8346 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8347 else
8349 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8351 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8352 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8353 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8354 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8355 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8356 ..._TYPE node. */
8357 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8358 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8359 else
8360 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8361 not the main variant. */
8362 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
8363 gcc_assert (mod_type_die);
8366 /* We want to equate the qualified type to the die below. */
8367 type = qualified_type;
8370 if (type)
8371 equate_type_number_to_die (type, mod_type_die);
8372 if (item_type)
8373 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8374 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8375 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8376 types are possible in Ada. */
8377 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8378 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8379 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8380 context_die);
8382 if (sub_die != NULL)
8383 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8385 return mod_type_die;
8388 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8389 an enumerated type. */
8391 static inline int
8392 type_is_enum (tree type)
8394 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8397 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8399 static unsigned int
8400 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8402 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8404 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8406 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8409 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8410 zero if there is none. */
8412 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8413 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8415 unsigned reg;
8416 rtx regs;
8418 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8419 return 0;
8421 reg = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
8422 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8424 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1
8425 || regs)
8426 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8427 else
8428 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (reg);
8431 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8432 a given hard register number. */
8434 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8435 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8437 if (regno <= 31)
8438 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8439 else
8440 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8443 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8444 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8446 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8447 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8449 int nregs, size, i;
8450 unsigned reg;
8451 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8453 reg = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
8454 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8456 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8457 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8459 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8461 loc_result = NULL;
8462 while (nregs--)
8464 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8466 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (reg);
8467 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8468 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0));
8469 ++reg;
8471 return loc_result;
8474 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8476 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8478 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8479 loc_result = NULL;
8481 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8483 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8485 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8486 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8487 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8488 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0));
8490 return loc_result;
8493 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8495 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8496 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8498 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8500 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8501 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8502 if (i >= 0)
8504 if (i <= 31)
8505 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8506 else if (i <= 0xff)
8507 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8508 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8509 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8510 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8511 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8512 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8513 else
8514 op = DW_OP_constu;
8516 else
8518 if (i >= -0x80)
8519 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8520 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8521 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8522 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8523 || i >= -0x80000000)
8524 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8525 else
8526 op = DW_OP_consts;
8529 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8532 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8534 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8535 based_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, bool can_use_fbreg)
8537 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
8538 /* For the "frame base", we use the frame pointer or stack pointer
8539 registers, since the RTL for local variables is relative to one of
8540 them. */
8541 unsigned fp_reg = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (frame_pointer_needed
8542 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8543 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
8545 if (reg == fp_reg && can_use_fbreg)
8546 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8547 else if (reg <= 31)
8548 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + reg, offset, 0);
8549 else
8550 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
8552 return loc_result;
8555 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8557 static inline int
8558 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8560 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8561 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8562 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8563 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8566 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8567 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8568 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8569 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8571 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8572 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8573 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8574 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8576 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8577 autoincrement addressing modes.
8579 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the location
8580 list for RTL. We can't use it when we are emitting location list for
8581 virtual variable frame_base_decl (i.e. a location list for DW_AT_frame_base)
8582 which describes how frame base changes when !frame_pointer_needed.
8584 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8586 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8587 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode, bool can_use_fbreg)
8589 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8590 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8592 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8593 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8594 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8595 zeroth element of the array. */
8597 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8599 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8601 case POST_INC:
8602 case POST_DEC:
8603 case POST_MODIFY:
8604 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8605 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8607 /* ... fall through ... */
8609 case SUBREG:
8610 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8611 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8612 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8613 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8614 contains the given subreg. */
8615 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8617 /* ... fall through ... */
8619 case REG:
8620 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8621 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8622 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8623 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8624 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8625 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8626 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8627 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8628 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8629 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8630 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8631 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8632 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8633 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8634 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (dbx_reg_number (rtl), 0,
8635 can_use_fbreg);
8636 break;
8638 case MEM:
8639 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
8640 can_use_fbreg);
8641 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8642 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8643 break;
8645 case LO_SUM:
8646 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8648 /* ... fall through ... */
8650 case LABEL_REF:
8651 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8652 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8653 pool. */
8654 case CONST:
8655 case SYMBOL_REF:
8656 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8657 by a different symbol. */
8658 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8660 bool marked;
8661 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8663 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8665 rtl = tmp;
8666 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8667 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8668 else
8669 marked = true;
8672 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8673 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8674 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8675 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8676 if (!marked)
8677 return 0;
8680 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8681 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8682 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8683 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
8684 break;
8686 case PRE_MODIFY:
8687 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8688 PLUS code below. */
8689 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8690 goto plus;
8692 case PRE_INC:
8693 case PRE_DEC:
8694 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8695 below. */
8696 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8697 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8698 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8699 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8701 /* ... fall through ... */
8703 case PLUS:
8704 plus:
8705 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8706 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (dbx_reg_number (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
8707 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
8708 can_use_fbreg);
8709 else
8711 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
8712 can_use_fbreg);
8713 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8714 break;
8716 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8717 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8718 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8719 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8720 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8721 else
8723 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8724 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
8725 can_use_fbreg));
8726 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8727 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8730 break;
8732 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8733 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
8734 case MULT:
8735 op = DW_OP_mul;
8736 goto do_binop;
8738 case ASHIFT:
8739 op = DW_OP_shl;
8740 goto do_binop;
8742 case ASHIFTRT:
8743 op = DW_OP_shra;
8744 goto do_binop;
8746 case LSHIFTRT:
8747 op = DW_OP_shr;
8748 goto do_binop;
8750 do_binop:
8752 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
8753 can_use_fbreg);
8754 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
8755 can_use_fbreg);
8757 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8758 break;
8760 mem_loc_result = op0;
8761 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
8762 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8763 break;
8766 case CONST_INT:
8767 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
8768 break;
8770 default:
8771 gcc_unreachable ();
8774 return mem_loc_result;
8777 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
8778 This is typically a complex variable. */
8780 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8781 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
8783 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
8784 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0, false);
8785 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1, false);
8787 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
8788 return 0;
8790 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
8791 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
8792 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
8793 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)), 0));
8795 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
8796 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
8797 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
8798 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)), 0));
8800 return cc_loc_result;
8803 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
8804 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
8805 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
8806 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
8807 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
8809 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
8811 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8812 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, bool can_use_fbreg)
8814 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8816 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8818 case SUBREG:
8819 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8820 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8821 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8822 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8823 contains the given subreg. */
8824 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8826 /* ... fall through ... */
8828 case REG:
8829 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
8830 break;
8832 case MEM:
8833 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
8834 can_use_fbreg);
8835 break;
8837 case CONCAT:
8838 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
8839 break;
8841 case VAR_LOCATION:
8842 /* Single part. */
8843 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
8845 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0), can_use_fbreg);
8846 break;
8849 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8850 /* FALLTHRU */
8852 case PARALLEL:
8854 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
8855 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
8856 enum machine_mode mode;
8857 int i;
8859 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
8860 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
8861 can_use_fbreg);
8862 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
8863 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
8864 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
8865 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
8867 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
8869 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
8870 can_use_fbreg);
8871 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
8872 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
8873 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
8874 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
8875 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
8878 break;
8880 default:
8881 gcc_unreachable ();
8884 return loc_result;
8887 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
8888 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
8889 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
8890 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
8891 the value of LOC. */
8893 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8894 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
8896 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
8897 int have_address = 0;
8898 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
8899 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8901 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
8902 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
8903 problem... */
8905 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
8907 case ERROR_MARK:
8908 return 0;
8910 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
8911 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
8912 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
8913 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
8914 the names of types. */
8915 return 0;
8917 case CALL_EXPR:
8918 return 0;
8920 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
8921 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
8922 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
8923 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
8924 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
8925 return 0;
8927 case ADDR_EXPR:
8928 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
8929 if (want_address)
8930 return 0;
8932 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
8933 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
8935 case VAR_DECL:
8936 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL (loc))
8938 rtx rtl;
8940 #ifndef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
8941 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
8942 return 0;
8943 #endif
8945 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
8946 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
8947 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
8948 return 0;
8950 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
8951 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8952 return 0;
8954 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
8955 return 0;
8956 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8957 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
8958 return 0;
8960 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
8961 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8962 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8964 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
8965 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
8967 have_address = 1;
8968 break;
8970 /* FALLTHRU */
8972 case PARM_DECL:
8973 if (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc))
8974 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc), want_address);
8975 /* FALLTHRU */
8977 case RESULT_DECL:
8979 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
8981 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8982 return 0;
8983 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
8985 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
8986 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
8987 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
8988 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
8990 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
8991 return 0;
8992 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
8994 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8995 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8996 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8998 else
9000 enum machine_mode mode;
9002 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9003 if (want_address == 2)
9004 return loc_descriptor (rtl, false);
9006 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9007 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9009 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9010 have_address = 1;
9012 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, false);
9015 break;
9017 case INDIRECT_REF:
9018 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9019 have_address = 1;
9020 break;
9022 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9023 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9025 case NOP_EXPR:
9026 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9027 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9028 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9029 case SAVE_EXPR:
9030 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9031 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9033 case COMPONENT_REF:
9034 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9035 case ARRAY_REF:
9036 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9038 tree obj, offset;
9039 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9040 enum machine_mode mode;
9041 int volatilep;
9043 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9044 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9046 if (obj == loc)
9047 return 0;
9049 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9050 if (ret == 0
9051 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9052 return 0;
9054 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9056 /* Variable offset. */
9057 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9058 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9061 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9062 if (bytepos > 0)
9063 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9064 else if (bytepos < 0)
9066 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9067 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9070 have_address = 1;
9071 break;
9074 case INTEGER_CST:
9075 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9076 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9077 else
9078 return 0;
9079 break;
9081 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9083 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9084 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9085 enum machine_mode mode;
9087 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9088 return 0;
9089 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9090 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9091 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, false);
9092 have_address = 1;
9093 break;
9096 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9097 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9098 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9099 op = DW_OP_and;
9100 goto do_binop;
9102 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9103 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9104 op = DW_OP_xor;
9105 goto do_binop;
9107 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9108 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9109 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9110 op = DW_OP_or;
9111 goto do_binop;
9113 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9114 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9115 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9116 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9117 op = DW_OP_div;
9118 goto do_binop;
9120 case MINUS_EXPR:
9121 op = DW_OP_minus;
9122 goto do_binop;
9124 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9125 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9126 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9127 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9128 op = DW_OP_mod;
9129 goto do_binop;
9131 case MULT_EXPR:
9132 op = DW_OP_mul;
9133 goto do_binop;
9135 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9136 op = DW_OP_shl;
9137 goto do_binop;
9139 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9140 op = (unsignedp ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9141 goto do_binop;
9143 case PLUS_EXPR:
9144 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9145 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9147 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9148 if (ret == 0)
9149 return 0;
9151 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9152 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9153 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9155 0));
9156 break;
9159 op = DW_OP_plus;
9160 goto do_binop;
9162 case LE_EXPR:
9163 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9164 return 0;
9166 op = DW_OP_le;
9167 goto do_binop;
9169 case GE_EXPR:
9170 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9171 return 0;
9173 op = DW_OP_ge;
9174 goto do_binop;
9176 case LT_EXPR:
9177 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9178 return 0;
9180 op = DW_OP_lt;
9181 goto do_binop;
9183 case GT_EXPR:
9184 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9185 return 0;
9187 op = DW_OP_gt;
9188 goto do_binop;
9190 case EQ_EXPR:
9191 op = DW_OP_eq;
9192 goto do_binop;
9194 case NE_EXPR:
9195 op = DW_OP_ne;
9196 goto do_binop;
9198 do_binop:
9199 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9200 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9201 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9202 return 0;
9204 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9205 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9206 break;
9208 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9209 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9210 op = DW_OP_not;
9211 goto do_unop;
9213 case ABS_EXPR:
9214 op = DW_OP_abs;
9215 goto do_unop;
9217 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9218 op = DW_OP_neg;
9219 goto do_unop;
9221 do_unop:
9222 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9223 if (ret == 0)
9224 return 0;
9226 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9227 break;
9229 case MIN_EXPR:
9230 case MAX_EXPR:
9232 const enum tree_code code =
9233 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9235 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9236 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9237 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9238 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9241 /* ... fall through ... */
9243 case COND_EXPR:
9245 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9246 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9247 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9248 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9249 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9251 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9252 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9253 return 0;
9255 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9256 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9258 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9259 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9260 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9262 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9263 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9264 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9266 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9267 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9268 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9269 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9270 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9272 break;
9274 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9275 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9276 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9277 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9278 return 0;
9280 default:
9281 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9282 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9283 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9284 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9285 return 0;
9287 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9288 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9289 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9290 gcc_unreachable ();
9291 #else
9292 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9293 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9294 return NULL;
9295 #endif
9298 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9299 if (want_address && !have_address)
9300 return 0;
9302 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9303 if (!want_address && have_address)
9305 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9307 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9308 return 0;
9309 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9310 op = DW_OP_deref;
9311 else
9312 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9314 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9317 return ret;
9320 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9321 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9323 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9326 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9327 which is not less than the value itself. */
9329 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9330 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9332 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9335 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9336 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9337 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9338 ERROR_MARK node. */
9340 static inline tree
9341 field_type (tree decl)
9343 tree type;
9345 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9346 return integer_type_node;
9348 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9349 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9350 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9352 return type;
9355 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9356 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9357 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9359 static inline unsigned
9360 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9362 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9365 static inline unsigned
9366 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9368 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9371 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9372 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9373 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9374 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9375 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9376 just yet). */
9378 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9379 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9381 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9382 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9383 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9384 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9385 tree type;
9386 tree field_size_tree;
9387 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9388 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9389 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9391 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9392 return 0;
9394 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9396 type = field_type (decl);
9397 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9399 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9400 a flexible array member. */
9401 if (! field_size_tree)
9402 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9404 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9405 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9406 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9407 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9408 return 0;
9410 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9412 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9413 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9414 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9415 else
9416 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9418 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9419 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9420 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9422 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9423 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9424 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
9425 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9426 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9427 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
9428 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9429 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9431 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9433 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9434 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9435 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9436 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9437 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9438 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9439 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9440 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9441 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9442 bits of the bit-field itself.
9444 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9445 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
9446 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9447 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9448 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9449 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9450 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
9451 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9452 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9454 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9455 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9456 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9457 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9458 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9459 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
9461 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9462 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
9463 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9465 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9466 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
9467 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9469 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
9470 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9471 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9472 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9474 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9476 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
9477 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9479 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
9480 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9481 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9482 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9485 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9488 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9489 associated with them. */
9491 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9493 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9494 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9495 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
9497 static inline void
9498 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9499 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9501 if (descr != 0)
9502 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9505 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9506 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9507 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9508 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9509 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9510 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
9511 function above).
9513 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9514 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9515 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9516 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9517 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
9518 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9519 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
9520 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
9521 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9522 function below.) */
9524 static void
9525 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9527 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9528 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9530 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9532 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9533 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9535 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9536 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9537 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9538 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9540 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9542 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9544 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9546 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9547 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9548 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9550 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9551 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9552 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9554 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9555 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9556 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9558 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9559 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9560 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9561 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9563 /* Extract the offset. */
9564 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9565 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9567 /* Add it to the object address. */
9568 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9569 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9571 else
9572 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9574 else
9575 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9577 if (! loc_descr)
9579 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9581 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9582 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9583 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9585 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9586 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9587 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9588 stack. */
9589 op = DW_OP_constu;
9590 #else
9591 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9592 #endif
9594 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9597 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9600 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
9602 static void
9603 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9605 while (size != 0)
9607 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9608 val >>= 8;
9609 --size;
9613 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
9615 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9616 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9618 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9620 src += size;
9621 while (size != 0)
9623 val <<= 8;
9624 val |= *--src & 0xff;
9625 --size;
9627 return val;
9630 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
9632 static void
9633 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9635 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9636 long val[4];
9637 int i;
9639 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9640 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9642 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
9643 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9645 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9646 array += 4;
9650 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9651 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9652 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9653 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9654 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9656 static void
9657 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9659 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9661 case CONST_INT:
9663 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9665 if (val < 0)
9666 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9667 else
9668 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9670 break;
9672 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9673 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9674 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9675 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9676 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9678 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9680 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
9682 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9683 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9685 insert_float (rtl, array);
9686 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9688 else
9690 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9691 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9693 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9694 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9697 break;
9699 case CONST_VECTOR:
9701 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9702 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9703 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9704 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9705 unsigned int i;
9706 unsigned char *p;
9708 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9710 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9711 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9713 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9714 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9716 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9718 case CONST_INT:
9719 lo = INTVAL (elt);
9720 hi = -(lo < 0);
9721 break;
9723 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9724 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9725 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9726 break;
9728 default:
9729 gcc_unreachable ();
9732 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9733 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9734 else
9736 unsigned char *p0 = p;
9737 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9739 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9740 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9742 p0 = p1;
9743 p1 = p;
9745 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9746 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9749 break;
9751 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9752 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9754 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9755 insert_float (elt, p);
9757 break;
9759 default:
9760 gcc_unreachable ();
9763 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9765 break;
9767 case CONST_STRING:
9768 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
9769 break;
9771 case SYMBOL_REF:
9772 case LABEL_REF:
9773 case CONST:
9774 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
9775 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
9776 break;
9778 case PLUS:
9779 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
9780 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
9781 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
9782 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
9783 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
9784 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
9785 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
9786 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
9787 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
9788 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
9789 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
9790 break;
9792 default:
9793 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
9794 gcc_unreachable ();
9799 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
9800 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
9802 static rtx
9803 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
9805 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
9807 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
9808 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
9809 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9811 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
9812 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9813 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
9815 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
9816 && domain
9817 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
9818 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
9819 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
9820 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
9821 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
9822 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
9823 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
9825 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
9826 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. Expanding anything else
9827 tends to produce unresolved symbols; see debug/5770 and c++/6381. */
9828 /* Aggregate, vector, and complex types may contain constructors that may
9829 result in code being generated when expand_expr is called, so we can't
9830 handle them here. Integer and float are useful and safe types to handle
9831 here. */
9832 else if ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) || SCALAR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (type))
9833 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
9835 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
9837 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
9838 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
9841 return rtl;
9844 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
9846 static rtx
9847 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
9849 rtx rtl;
9851 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
9852 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
9853 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
9855 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
9856 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
9857 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
9858 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
9859 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
9860 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
9861 referenced within the function.
9863 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
9864 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
9865 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
9866 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
9868 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
9869 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
9870 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
9871 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
9872 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
9873 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
9875 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
9876 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
9877 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
9878 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
9879 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
9880 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
9881 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
9882 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
9883 output at debug-time.
9885 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
9886 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
9887 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
9888 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
9889 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
9890 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
9891 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
9892 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
9893 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
9894 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
9895 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
9896 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
9897 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
9899 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
9900 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
9901 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
9902 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
9903 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
9904 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
9905 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
9906 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
9907 I'd like to fix it.
9909 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
9910 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
9911 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
9912 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
9913 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
9914 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
9915 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
9916 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
9917 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
9918 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
9919 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
9921 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
9922 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
9924 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
9925 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
9926 fixed registers. */
9927 if (! reload_completed)
9929 if (rtl
9930 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
9931 || (MEM_P (rtl)
9932 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
9933 || (REG_P (rtl)
9934 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
9935 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
9937 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
9938 return rtl;
9940 rtl = NULL_RTX;
9942 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
9944 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
9946 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9947 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
9948 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
9949 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
9951 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
9952 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
9953 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
9954 if (dmode == pmode)
9955 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
9956 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
9957 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
9958 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
9960 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
9961 if (REG_P (inc))
9962 rtl = inc;
9963 else if (MEM_P (inc))
9965 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
9966 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
9967 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
9968 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
9969 else
9970 rtl = inc;
9975 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
9976 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
9977 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
9978 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
9979 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
9980 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
9981 thing to do. */
9982 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
9983 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
9984 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
9985 /* Not passed in memory. */
9986 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
9987 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
9988 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
9989 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
9990 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
9991 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
9992 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
9993 #endif
9995 /* Big endian correction check. */
9996 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9997 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
9998 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
9999 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10001 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10002 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10004 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10005 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10008 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10009 && rtl
10010 && MEM_P (rtl)
10011 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10012 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10014 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10015 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10017 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10018 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10019 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10020 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10021 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10022 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10023 if (rsize > dsize)
10024 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10025 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10028 if (rtl != NULL_RTX)
10030 rtl = eliminate_regs (rtl, 0, NULL_RTX);
10031 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
10032 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
10033 leaf_renumber_regs_insn (rtl);
10034 #endif
10037 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10038 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10039 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10040 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10041 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10043 if (rtl)
10044 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10046 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10047 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10048 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10049 if (rtl)
10050 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10052 return rtl;
10055 /* Return true if DECL's containing function has a frame base attribute.
10056 Return false otherwise. */
10058 static bool
10059 containing_function_has_frame_base (tree decl)
10061 tree declcontext = decl_function_context (decl);
10062 dw_die_ref context;
10063 dw_attr_ref attr;
10065 if (!declcontext)
10066 return false;
10068 context = lookup_decl_die (declcontext);
10069 if (!context)
10070 return false;
10072 for (attr = context->die_attr; attr; attr = attr->dw_attr_next)
10073 if (attr->dw_attr == DW_AT_frame_base)
10074 return true;
10075 return false;
10078 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10079 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10080 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10081 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10082 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10083 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10084 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10085 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10086 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10087 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10089 static void
10090 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10091 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10093 rtx rtl;
10094 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10095 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10096 bool can_use_fb;
10097 struct var_loc_node *node;
10098 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10099 return;
10101 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10102 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10104 can_use_fb = containing_function_has_frame_base (decl);
10106 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10107 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10109 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10110 differ. */
10111 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10113 const char *secname;
10114 const char *endname;
10115 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10116 rtx varloc;
10118 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base
10119 for the address ranges where a given location is valid.
10120 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it,
10121 use that.
10122 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use
10123 that.
10124 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10125 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, this
10126 won't notice. */
10128 if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10130 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10131 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10133 else if (current_function_decl
10134 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10136 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10137 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10139 else if (cfun
10140 && (last_text_section == in_unlikely_executed_text
10141 || (last_text_section == in_named
10142 && last_text_section_name ==
10143 cfun->unlikely_text_section_name)))
10144 secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10145 else
10146 secname = text_section_label;
10148 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10149 actually construct the list of locations.
10150 The first location information is what is passed to the
10151 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10152 locations just get added on to that list.
10153 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10154 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10155 the range [current location start, next location start].
10156 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10157 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10159 node = loc_list->first;
10160 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10161 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc, can_use_fb),
10162 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10163 node = node->next;
10165 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10166 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10168 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10169 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10170 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10171 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list,
10172 loc_descriptor (varloc,
10173 can_use_fb),
10174 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10177 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10178 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10179 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10181 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10183 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10184 if (!current_function_decl)
10185 endname = text_end_label;
10186 else
10188 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10189 current_function_funcdef_no);
10190 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10192 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list,
10193 loc_descriptor (varloc,
10194 can_use_fb),
10195 node->label, endname, secname);
10198 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10199 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10200 return;
10203 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10204 the location. */
10206 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10207 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10209 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10210 return;
10213 /* We couldn't get any rtl, and we had no >1 element location list, so try
10214 directly generating the location description from the tree. */
10215 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10216 if (descr)
10218 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10219 return;
10222 /* Lastly, if we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10223 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10224 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10225 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10227 node = loc_list->first;
10228 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note),
10229 can_use_fb);
10230 if (descr)
10231 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10235 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10236 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10237 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10239 static void
10240 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10242 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10243 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10244 rtx rtl;
10246 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10247 /* OK */;
10248 else
10249 return;
10251 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10252 if (rtl)
10253 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10256 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10257 the value of the attribute. */
10259 static void
10260 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10262 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10264 if (demangle_name_func)
10265 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10267 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10271 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
10273 static void
10274 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10276 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10277 if (wd != NULL)
10278 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10281 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10282 a representation for that bound. */
10284 static void
10285 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10287 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10289 case ERROR_MARK:
10290 return;
10292 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
10293 case INTEGER_CST:
10294 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10295 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10296 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
10297 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10298 /* Use the default. */
10300 else
10301 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10302 break;
10304 case CONVERT_EXPR:
10305 case NOP_EXPR:
10306 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10307 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10308 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10309 break;
10311 case SAVE_EXPR:
10312 break;
10314 case VAR_DECL:
10315 case PARM_DECL:
10316 case RESULT_DECL:
10318 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10320 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10321 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10322 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10323 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10324 later parameter. */
10325 if (decl_die != NULL)
10326 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10327 break;
10330 default:
10332 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10333 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
10335 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10336 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10338 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10339 if (loc == NULL)
10340 break;
10342 if (current_function_decl == 0)
10343 ctx = comp_unit_die;
10344 else
10345 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10347 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10348 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10349 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10350 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10352 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10353 break;
10358 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10359 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
10361 static void
10362 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10364 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10365 unsigned dimension_number;
10366 #endif
10367 tree lower, upper;
10368 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10370 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10371 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10372 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10373 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10374 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10375 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10376 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10377 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
10379 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10380 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10381 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10382 gen_array_type_die. */
10383 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10384 for (dimension_number = 0;
10385 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10386 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10387 #endif
10389 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10391 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10392 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
10393 here. */
10394 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10395 if (domain)
10397 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
10398 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10399 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10401 /* Define the index type. */
10402 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10404 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
10405 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
10406 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
10407 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10408 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10409 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10410 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10412 else
10413 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10414 type_die);
10417 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10418 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
10419 dimension arr(N:*)
10420 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10421 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10422 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
10424 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10425 if (upper)
10426 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10429 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
10430 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10431 bounds. */
10435 static void
10436 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10438 unsigned size;
10440 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10442 case ERROR_MARK:
10443 size = 0;
10444 break;
10445 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10446 case RECORD_TYPE:
10447 case UNION_TYPE:
10448 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10449 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10450 break;
10451 case FIELD_DECL:
10452 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10453 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10454 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
10455 even for bit-fields. */
10456 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10457 break;
10458 default:
10459 gcc_unreachable ();
10462 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
10463 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
10464 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
10465 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
10466 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
10469 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10470 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10471 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10472 bit-field itself.
10474 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10475 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10476 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10477 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
10478 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10479 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10481 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10482 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10483 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
10485 static inline void
10486 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10488 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10489 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10490 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10491 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10492 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10493 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10495 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10496 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10498 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10499 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10500 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
10501 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10502 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10503 return;
10505 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10507 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10508 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10509 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10510 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10511 below must take account of these differences. */
10512 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10513 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10515 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10517 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10518 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10521 bit_offset
10522 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10523 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10524 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10526 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10529 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10530 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
10532 static inline void
10533 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10535 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10536 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10537 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10539 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10540 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10543 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10544 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
10546 static inline void
10547 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10549 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10550 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10551 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10554 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
10555 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10556 equate table. */
10558 static inline void
10559 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10561 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10563 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10565 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10566 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10567 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10569 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10570 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
10571 tree fn = origin;
10573 if (TYPE_P (fn))
10574 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10576 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10577 if (fn)
10578 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10581 if (DECL_P (origin))
10582 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10583 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10584 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10586 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10587 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10588 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10589 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
10590 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10591 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
10592 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10593 here. */
10595 if (origin_die)
10596 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10599 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
10601 static inline void
10602 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10604 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10606 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10608 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
10609 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
10610 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
10611 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
10612 0));
10614 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
10615 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10616 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10617 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
10621 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
10623 static void
10624 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10626 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
10627 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
10629 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10630 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
10633 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
10634 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
10636 static void
10637 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10639 tree decl_name;
10641 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
10642 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
10644 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
10645 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10646 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
10648 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
10649 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10650 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
10651 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10652 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
10653 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
10656 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10657 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
10658 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
10659 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
10661 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
10662 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10663 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
10665 #endif
10668 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
10670 static void
10671 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
10673 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
10676 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
10678 static inline void
10679 pop_decl_scope (void)
10681 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
10684 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
10685 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
10686 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
10687 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
10688 the current active scope. */
10690 static dw_die_ref
10691 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
10693 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
10694 tree containing_scope;
10695 int i;
10697 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
10698 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
10700 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
10702 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
10703 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10705 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
10706 /* OK */;
10707 else
10708 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10711 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
10712 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
10713 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
10714 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
10715 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
10717 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
10718 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10719 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
10721 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
10722 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
10723 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
10724 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10725 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
10726 break;
10728 if (i < 0)
10730 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
10731 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
10733 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
10734 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10736 else
10737 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
10739 else
10740 scope_die = context_die;
10742 return scope_die;
10745 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
10747 static inline int
10748 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10750 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
10751 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
10752 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10753 return 1;
10755 return 0;
10758 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
10759 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
10761 static inline int
10762 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10764 return (context_die
10765 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10766 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
10767 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
10770 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
10771 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
10772 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
10774 static void
10775 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
10776 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
10778 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
10779 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
10781 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
10782 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
10783 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
10784 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
10785 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
10786 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
10787 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
10789 if (code == ERROR_MARK
10790 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
10791 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
10792 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
10793 || code == VOID_TYPE)
10794 return;
10796 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
10797 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
10798 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
10799 context_die);
10801 if (type_die != NULL)
10802 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
10805 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
10806 function call type. */
10807 static void
10808 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
10810 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
10812 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
10814 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
10815 is not DW_CC_normal. */
10816 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
10817 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
10820 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
10821 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
10822 was declared without a tag. */
10824 static const char *
10825 type_tag (tree type)
10827 const char *name = 0;
10829 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
10831 tree t = 0;
10833 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
10834 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
10835 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
10837 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
10838 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
10839 involved. */
10840 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
10841 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
10842 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
10844 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
10845 if (t != 0)
10846 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
10849 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
10852 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
10853 for bit field types. */
10855 static inline tree
10856 member_declared_type (tree member)
10858 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
10859 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
10862 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
10863 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
10865 #if 0
10866 static const char *
10867 decl_start_label (tree decl)
10869 rtx x;
10870 const char *fnname;
10872 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
10873 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
10875 x = XEXP (x, 0);
10876 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
10878 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
10879 return fnname;
10881 #endif
10883 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
10884 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
10885 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
10887 static void
10888 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10890 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
10891 dw_die_ref array_die;
10892 tree element_type;
10894 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
10895 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
10896 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
10897 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10898 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
10899 #endif
10901 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
10902 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
10903 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
10905 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10907 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
10908 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
10909 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
10910 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
10913 #if 0
10914 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
10915 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
10916 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
10917 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
10918 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
10919 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
10920 for multidimensional arrays. */
10921 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
10922 #endif
10924 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10925 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
10926 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
10927 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
10928 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10929 else
10930 #endif
10931 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
10933 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
10934 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10936 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10937 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10938 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10939 add_subscript_info. */
10940 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10941 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10942 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
10944 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
10945 #endif
10947 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
10950 #if 0
10951 static void
10952 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
10954 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10955 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
10957 if (origin != NULL)
10958 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
10959 else
10961 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
10962 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10963 0, 0, context_die);
10966 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10967 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
10968 else
10969 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
10971 #endif
10973 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
10974 emit full debugging info for them. */
10976 static void
10977 retry_incomplete_types (void)
10979 int i;
10981 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
10982 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
10985 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
10987 static void
10988 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10990 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
10992 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
10993 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
10994 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
10997 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
10999 static void
11000 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11002 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11004 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11005 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11006 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11009 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11011 static void
11012 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11014 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11016 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11017 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11018 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11021 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11022 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11023 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11024 DIE. */
11026 static dw_die_ref
11027 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11029 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11031 if (type_die == NULL)
11033 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11034 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11035 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11036 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11038 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11039 return type_die;
11040 else
11041 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11043 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
11044 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11045 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
11046 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11048 tree link;
11050 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11051 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11052 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11053 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11055 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11056 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11057 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11058 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11060 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11061 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11063 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11064 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11066 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11067 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11069 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11070 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11071 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
11072 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11073 values as if they were signed. That means that
11074 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11075 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
11076 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11077 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11080 else
11081 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11083 return type_die;
11086 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11087 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11088 type.
11090 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11091 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11092 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11093 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11094 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
11095 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11096 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11097 argument type of some subprogram type. */
11099 static dw_die_ref
11100 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11102 dw_die_ref parm_die
11103 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11104 tree origin;
11106 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11108 case tcc_declaration:
11109 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11110 if (origin != NULL)
11111 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11112 else
11114 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11115 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11116 TREE_READONLY (node),
11117 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11118 context_die);
11119 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11120 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11123 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11124 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11125 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11127 break;
11129 case tcc_type:
11130 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
11131 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11132 break;
11134 default:
11135 gcc_unreachable ();
11138 return parm_die;
11141 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11142 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
11144 static void
11145 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11147 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11150 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11151 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11152 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11153 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
11155 static void
11156 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11158 tree link;
11159 tree formal_type = NULL;
11160 tree first_parm_type;
11161 tree arg;
11163 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11165 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11166 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11168 else
11169 arg = NULL_TREE;
11171 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11173 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11174 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
11175 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11177 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11179 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11180 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11181 break;
11183 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
11184 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11185 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11186 && link == first_parm_type)
11187 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11188 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11190 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11191 if (arg)
11192 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11195 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11196 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
11197 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11198 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11200 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11201 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
11202 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11203 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11204 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11205 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11208 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11209 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11210 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
11211 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11212 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
11214 static void
11215 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11217 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11219 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11220 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
11221 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11222 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11224 dw_die_ref type_die;
11225 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11227 push_decl_scope (type);
11228 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11229 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11230 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11231 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11233 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11234 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
11235 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11236 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11237 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11239 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11240 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11243 else
11244 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11246 pop_decl_scope ();
11250 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11251 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
11253 static void
11254 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11256 dw_die_ref old_die;
11257 tree save_fn;
11258 tree context;
11259 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11261 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
11262 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11264 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11265 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11266 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
11267 return;
11269 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11270 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
11271 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11273 context = decl_class_context (decl);
11274 if (context)
11275 gen_type_die_for_member
11276 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11279 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
11280 save_fn = current_function_decl;
11281 current_function_decl = decl;
11283 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11284 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11285 if (! was_abstract)
11286 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11288 current_function_decl = save_fn;
11291 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11292 block-local). */
11294 static void
11295 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11297 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11298 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11299 dw_die_ref subr_die;
11300 rtx fp_reg;
11301 tree fn_arg_types;
11302 tree outer_scope;
11303 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11304 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11305 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11307 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11308 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11309 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11310 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11311 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
11313 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
11314 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11316 origin = NULL;
11317 gcc_assert (!old_die);
11320 if (origin != NULL)
11322 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11324 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11325 inline function. */
11326 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11327 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11329 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11330 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11332 else if (old_die)
11334 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11335 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11337 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11338 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11339 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11340 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
11341 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11343 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11344 something we have already output. */
11345 return;
11348 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11349 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
11350 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11351 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
11352 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11353 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
11354 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
11355 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11356 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11357 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11358 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11359 == (unsigned) s.line))))
11361 subr_die = old_die;
11363 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11364 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11365 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11366 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11367 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
11368 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11369 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11371 else
11373 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11374 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11375 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11376 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11377 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11378 != (unsigned) s.line)
11379 add_AT_unsigned
11380 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11383 else
11385 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11387 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11388 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11390 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11391 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11393 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11394 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11395 0, 0, context_die);
11398 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11399 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11400 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11402 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11403 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11404 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11405 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11408 if (declaration)
11410 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11412 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11414 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11415 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
11416 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
11417 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
11419 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11420 later reused to represent definition. */
11421 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11424 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11426 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11428 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11429 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11430 else
11431 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11433 else
11435 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11436 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11437 else
11438 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11441 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11443 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11445 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11446 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11448 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11450 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11451 current_function_funcdef_no);
11452 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11453 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11454 current_function_funcdef_no);
11455 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11457 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11458 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11460 else
11461 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11462 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11463 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
11465 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11466 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11467 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11468 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11470 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11471 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11472 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11476 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11477 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
11478 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11479 #endif
11481 /* Define the "frame base" location for this routine. We use the
11482 frame pointer or stack pointer registers, since the RTL for local
11483 variables is relative to one of them. */
11484 if (frame_base_decl && lookup_decl_loc (frame_base_decl) != NULL)
11486 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (subr_die, frame_base_decl,
11487 DW_AT_frame_base);
11489 else
11491 fp_reg
11492 = frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx : stack_pointer_rtx;
11493 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, reg_loc_descriptor (fp_reg));
11496 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11497 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11498 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11501 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11502 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11503 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11504 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
11505 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11506 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
11507 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11508 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11509 an ellipsis at the end. */
11511 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11512 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11513 its formal parameters. */
11514 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11516 else if (declaration)
11517 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11518 else
11520 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
11521 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11522 tree parm;
11524 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11525 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11526 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11527 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11529 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11530 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11531 "__builtin_va_alist"))
11532 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11533 else
11534 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11537 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11538 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11539 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11540 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11541 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
11542 parameters at all. */
11543 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11544 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11546 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
11547 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11548 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11550 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11551 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11554 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
11555 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
11556 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11558 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
11559 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
11560 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
11561 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
11562 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
11563 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
11564 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
11566 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
11567 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
11568 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
11569 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
11570 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
11571 constructor function. */
11572 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
11574 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
11575 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
11576 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
11578 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
11579 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
11581 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11582 if (current_function_has_inlines)
11584 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11585 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
11587 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11588 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
11591 #endif
11593 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
11594 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11598 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
11600 static void
11601 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11603 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11604 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
11606 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11607 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
11608 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11610 if (origin != NULL)
11611 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
11613 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
11614 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
11616 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
11617 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
11618 sharing them.
11620 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
11622 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
11623 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
11624 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
11625 declaration. */
11626 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
11627 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
11629 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
11630 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
11631 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
11633 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11634 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11636 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11637 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11639 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11640 != (unsigned) s.line)
11642 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11645 else
11647 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
11648 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
11649 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
11651 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11652 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11654 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11655 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11657 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11658 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11659 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11660 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11663 if (declaration)
11664 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11666 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
11667 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
11669 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11671 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
11672 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
11674 else
11675 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
11678 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
11680 static void
11681 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11683 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11684 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
11685 rtx insn;
11686 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11688 if (origin != NULL)
11689 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
11690 else
11691 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
11693 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11694 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
11695 else
11697 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
11699 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
11700 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
11701 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
11702 if (insn
11703 && (LABEL_P (insn)
11704 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
11705 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
11707 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
11708 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
11709 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
11710 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
11711 it if it ever does happen. */
11712 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
11714 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
11715 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
11720 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
11721 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
11723 static inline void
11724 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
11726 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11728 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
11730 tree chain;
11732 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
11734 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
11737 add_ranges (chain);
11738 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
11740 while (chain);
11741 add_ranges (NULL);
11743 else
11745 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
11746 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
11747 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
11748 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
11749 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
11750 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
11754 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
11756 static void
11757 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
11759 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
11761 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
11762 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
11764 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
11767 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
11769 static void
11770 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
11772 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
11774 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
11775 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
11776 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
11777 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
11778 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
11780 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
11782 dw_die_ref subr_die
11783 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
11785 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11786 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
11788 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
11789 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
11791 else
11792 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
11793 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
11794 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
11795 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
11796 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
11797 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
11798 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
11799 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
11800 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
11801 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
11802 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
11803 intended :-) */
11804 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11807 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
11809 static void
11810 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11812 dw_die_ref decl_die;
11814 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
11815 return;
11817 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
11818 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11819 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
11820 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
11821 context_die);
11823 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
11825 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11826 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11827 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11830 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
11831 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11833 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11834 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11836 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11837 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11838 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11839 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11841 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
11842 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11845 #if 0
11846 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
11847 Use modified_type_die instead.
11848 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
11849 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
11851 static void
11852 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11854 dw_die_ref ptr_die
11855 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11857 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
11858 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
11859 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
11862 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
11863 Use modified_type_die instead.
11864 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
11865 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
11867 static void
11868 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11870 dw_die_ref ref_die
11871 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11873 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
11874 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
11875 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
11877 #endif
11879 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
11881 static void
11882 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11884 dw_die_ref ptr_die
11885 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
11886 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11888 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
11889 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11890 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
11891 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
11894 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
11896 static dw_die_ref
11897 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
11899 dw_die_ref die;
11900 char producer[250];
11901 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
11902 int language;
11904 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
11906 if (filename)
11908 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
11909 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
11910 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
11911 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
11914 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
11916 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11917 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
11918 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
11919 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
11920 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
11921 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
11922 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
11923 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11924 strcat (producer, " -g");
11925 #endif
11927 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
11929 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
11930 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
11931 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
11932 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
11933 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
11934 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
11935 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
11936 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
11937 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
11938 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
11939 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
11940 language = DW_LANG_Java;
11941 else
11942 language = DW_LANG_C89;
11944 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
11945 return die;
11948 /* Generate a DIE for a string type. */
11950 static void
11951 gen_string_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11953 dw_die_ref type_die
11954 = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11956 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11958 /* ??? Fudge the string length attribute for now.
11959 TODO: add string length info. */
11960 #if 0
11961 string_length_attribute (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
11962 bound_representation (upper_bound, 0, 'u');
11963 #endif
11966 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
11968 static void
11969 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
11971 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
11973 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
11974 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
11976 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
11977 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
11979 if (access == access_public_node)
11980 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
11981 else if (access == access_protected_node)
11982 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11985 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
11987 static void
11988 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11990 tree member;
11991 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
11992 dw_die_ref child;
11994 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
11995 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
11996 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
11997 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
11998 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
11999 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12000 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12001 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
12002 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12003 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12004 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
12006 /* First output info about the base classes. */
12007 if (binfo)
12009 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12010 int i;
12011 tree base;
12013 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12014 gen_inheritance_die (base,
12015 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12016 : access_public_node), context_die);
12019 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
12020 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12022 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12023 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12024 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
12025 do put them in the right order. */
12027 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12028 if (child)
12029 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12030 else
12031 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12034 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
12035 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12037 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
12038 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12039 continue;
12041 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12042 if (child)
12043 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12044 else
12045 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12049 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12050 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12051 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
12053 static void
12054 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12056 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12057 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12058 int nested = 0;
12059 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12060 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12061 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12062 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12064 if (type_die && ! complete)
12065 return;
12067 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12068 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12069 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12070 nested = 1;
12072 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12074 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12075 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
12077 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12079 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12080 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12081 scope_die, type);
12082 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12083 if (old_die)
12084 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12085 else
12086 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12088 else
12089 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12091 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12092 then give a list of members. */
12093 if (complete && !ns_decl)
12095 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12096 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
12097 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12098 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12099 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12100 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12102 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12103 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12104 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12105 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12107 push_decl_scope (type);
12108 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12109 pop_decl_scope ();
12111 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
12112 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12114 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12116 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12117 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12118 lookup_type_die (vtype));
12121 else
12123 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12125 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
12126 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12127 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12128 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12132 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
12134 static void
12135 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12137 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12138 dw_die_ref subr_die
12139 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12140 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12142 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12143 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12144 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12145 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12148 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
12150 static void
12151 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12153 dw_die_ref type_die;
12154 tree origin;
12156 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12157 return;
12159 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12160 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12161 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12162 if (origin != NULL)
12163 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12164 else
12166 tree type;
12168 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12169 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12171 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12173 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12174 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12176 else
12177 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12179 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12180 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12183 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12184 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12187 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
12189 static void
12190 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12192 int need_pop;
12194 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12195 return;
12197 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12198 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12200 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12201 return;
12203 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
12204 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12206 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12207 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12208 return;
12211 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12212 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12213 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12214 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12215 cloned type itself). */
12216 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12217 type = type_main_variant (type);
12219 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12220 return;
12222 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12224 case ERROR_MARK:
12225 break;
12227 case POINTER_TYPE:
12228 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12229 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
12230 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12231 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
12232 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12233 statement. */
12234 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12236 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12237 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
12238 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12239 break;
12241 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12242 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12243 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
12244 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
12246 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
12247 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12249 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12250 itself. */
12251 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12252 break;
12254 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12255 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12256 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12257 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12258 break;
12260 case METHOD_TYPE:
12261 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12262 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12263 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12264 break;
12266 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12267 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == CHAR_TYPE)
12269 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12270 gen_string_type_die (type, context_die);
12272 else
12273 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12274 break;
12276 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12277 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12278 break;
12280 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12281 case RECORD_TYPE:
12282 case UNION_TYPE:
12283 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12284 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12285 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
12286 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12287 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
12288 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12289 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
12290 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12291 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12292 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12294 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
12296 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12297 return;
12299 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
12300 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12301 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12302 need_pop = 1;
12304 else
12306 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12307 need_pop = 0;
12310 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12311 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12312 else
12313 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12315 if (need_pop)
12316 pop_decl_scope ();
12318 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12319 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12320 when appropriate. */
12321 return;
12323 case VOID_TYPE:
12324 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12325 case REAL_TYPE:
12326 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12327 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12328 case CHAR_TYPE:
12329 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
12330 break;
12332 case LANG_TYPE:
12333 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
12334 break;
12336 default:
12337 gcc_unreachable ();
12340 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12343 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
12345 static void
12346 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12348 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12349 return;
12351 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12352 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12353 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12354 type now. */
12355 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12357 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12358 an instance of an unresolved type. */
12360 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12362 case ERROR_MARK:
12363 break;
12365 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12366 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12367 break;
12369 case RECORD_TYPE:
12370 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12371 break;
12373 case UNION_TYPE:
12374 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12375 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12376 break;
12378 default:
12379 gcc_unreachable ();
12383 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12384 things which are local to the given block. */
12386 static void
12387 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12389 int must_output_die = 0;
12390 tree origin;
12391 tree decl;
12392 enum tree_code origin_code;
12394 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
12395 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12396 return;
12398 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12399 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12400 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
12401 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12403 tree sub;
12405 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12406 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12408 return;
12411 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
12412 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12413 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12414 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12415 the current block. */
12416 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12417 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12419 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12420 block. */
12421 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12422 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
12423 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
12424 must_output_die = 1;
12425 else
12427 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12428 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12429 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12430 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12431 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
12432 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12433 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
12434 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12436 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12437 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
12438 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12439 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12440 as being a "significant" one. */
12441 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12442 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12443 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12444 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12445 else
12446 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12447 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
12448 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12449 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12450 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12451 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12453 must_output_die = 1;
12454 break;
12459 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12460 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12461 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12462 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12463 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12464 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12465 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
12466 if (must_output_die)
12468 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12469 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12470 else
12471 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12473 else
12474 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12477 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12478 all of its sub-blocks. */
12480 static void
12481 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12483 tree decl;
12484 tree subblocks;
12486 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
12487 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12488 return;
12490 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12492 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12493 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12494 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12495 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
12496 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12498 dw_die_ref die;
12500 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12501 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12502 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12503 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12504 else
12505 die = NULL;
12507 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12508 add_child_die (context_die, die);
12509 else
12510 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12514 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
12515 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12516 return;
12518 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
12519 therein) of this block. */
12520 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
12521 subblocks != NULL;
12522 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
12523 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
12526 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
12528 static inline int
12529 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
12531 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12532 return 1;
12534 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
12535 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
12536 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
12537 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
12538 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
12539 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
12540 return 1;
12542 return 0;
12545 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
12547 static dw_die_ref
12548 force_decl_die (tree decl)
12550 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12551 unsigned saved_external_flag;
12552 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
12553 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12554 if (!decl_die)
12556 dw_die_ref context_die;
12557 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
12558 if (decl_context)
12560 /* Find die that represents this context. */
12561 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
12562 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
12563 else
12564 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
12566 else
12567 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12569 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12571 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12572 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
12573 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
12574 declaration die. */
12575 save_fn = current_function_decl;
12576 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
12577 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
12578 current_function_decl = save_fn;
12579 break;
12581 case VAR_DECL:
12582 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
12583 gen_decl_die() call. */
12584 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
12585 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
12586 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12587 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
12588 break;
12590 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
12591 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12592 break;
12594 default:
12595 gcc_unreachable ();
12598 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
12599 if (!decl_die)
12600 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12601 gcc_assert (decl_die);
12604 return decl_die;
12607 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE. A DIE is always returned. */
12609 static dw_die_ref
12610 force_type_die (tree type)
12612 dw_die_ref type_die;
12614 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12615 if (!type_die)
12617 dw_die_ref context_die;
12618 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12619 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12620 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12621 else
12622 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12623 else
12624 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12626 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12627 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12628 gcc_assert (type_die);
12630 return type_die;
12633 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
12634 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
12636 static dw_die_ref
12637 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12639 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
12640 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
12641 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
12642 /* Force out the namespace. */
12643 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
12645 return context_die;
12648 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
12649 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
12651 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
12652 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
12654 static void
12655 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
12657 dw_die_ref ns_context;
12659 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12660 return;
12662 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
12663 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
12664 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
12665 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
12666 return;
12668 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
12670 if (ns_context != context_die)
12672 if (DECL_P (thing))
12673 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
12674 else
12675 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
12679 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
12681 static void
12682 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
12684 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
12686 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
12687 they are an alias of. */
12688 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
12690 /* Output a real namespace. */
12691 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12692 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
12693 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12694 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12696 else
12698 /* Output a namespace alias. */
12700 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
12701 dw_die_ref origin_die
12702 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
12704 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
12705 dw_die_ref namespace_die
12706 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
12707 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
12708 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
12709 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
12713 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
12715 static void
12716 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12718 tree origin;
12720 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
12721 return;
12723 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
12725 case ERROR_MARK:
12726 break;
12728 case CONST_DECL:
12729 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
12730 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
12731 break;
12733 case FUNCTION_DECL:
12734 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
12735 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
12736 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
12737 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
12738 break;
12740 #if 0
12741 /* FIXME */
12742 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
12743 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
12744 if (current_function_decl != decl)
12745 /* This is only a declaration. */;
12746 #endif
12748 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
12749 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
12750 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
12752 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
12753 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
12754 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
12755 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
12756 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
12757 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
12758 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
12759 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
12760 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
12762 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12763 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
12766 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
12767 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12769 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
12770 have described its return type. */
12771 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
12773 /* And its virtual context. */
12774 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
12775 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
12777 /* And its containing type. */
12778 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
12779 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
12780 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
12782 /* And its containing namespace. */
12783 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
12786 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
12787 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
12788 break;
12790 case TYPE_DECL:
12791 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
12792 actual typedefs. */
12793 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12794 break;
12796 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
12797 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
12798 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
12799 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
12800 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
12801 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
12802 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
12804 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
12805 break;
12808 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
12809 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
12810 else
12811 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
12812 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
12813 break;
12815 case LABEL_DECL:
12816 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
12817 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
12818 break;
12820 case VAR_DECL:
12821 case RESULT_DECL:
12822 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
12823 variable declarations or definitions. */
12824 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12825 break;
12827 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
12828 object. */
12829 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
12831 /* And its containing type. */
12832 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
12833 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
12834 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
12836 /* And its containing namespace. */
12837 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
12839 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
12840 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
12841 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
12842 function. */
12843 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12844 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
12845 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
12846 else
12847 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
12848 break;
12850 case FIELD_DECL:
12851 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
12852 anonymous unions and structs. */
12853 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
12854 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
12855 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
12857 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
12858 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
12860 break;
12862 case PARM_DECL:
12863 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
12864 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
12865 break;
12867 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
12868 gen_namespace_die (decl);
12869 break;
12871 default:
12872 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
12873 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
12874 break;
12878 /* Add Ada "use" clause information for SGI Workshop debugger. */
12880 void
12881 dwarf2out_add_library_unit_info (const char *filename, const char *context_list)
12883 unsigned int file_index;
12885 if (filename != NULL)
12887 dw_die_ref unit_die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, comp_unit_die, NULL);
12888 tree context_list_decl
12889 = build_decl (LABEL_DECL, get_identifier (context_list),
12890 void_type_node);
12892 TREE_PUBLIC (context_list_decl) = TRUE;
12893 add_name_attribute (unit_die, context_list);
12894 file_index = lookup_filename (filename);
12895 add_AT_unsigned (unit_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12896 add_pubname (context_list_decl, unit_die);
12900 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
12901 compilation proper has finished. */
12903 static void
12904 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
12906 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
12907 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
12908 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
12909 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
12910 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12911 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12914 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
12915 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
12916 static void
12917 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
12919 if (!local)
12920 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12923 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
12925 static void
12926 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
12928 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
12929 dw_die_ref scope_die;
12930 unsigned file_index;
12931 expanded_location xloc;
12933 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12934 return;
12936 gcc_assert (decl);
12938 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
12939 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
12940 itself. */
12942 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
12943 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
12944 if (!context)
12945 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
12946 else if (TYPE_P (context))
12947 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
12948 else
12949 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
12951 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
12952 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
12953 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12954 else
12956 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12957 if (!at_import_die)
12959 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
12960 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
12961 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
12963 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
12964 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
12966 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12967 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12968 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12969 else
12970 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12971 else
12972 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
12973 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
12975 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
12979 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
12980 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
12981 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
12982 else
12983 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
12985 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
12986 file_index = lookup_filename (xloc.file);
12987 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12988 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
12989 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
12992 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
12994 void
12995 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
12997 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
12999 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13001 case ERROR_MARK:
13002 return;
13004 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13005 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13006 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13007 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13008 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13009 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13010 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13011 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
13012 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13013 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13014 with the definition of the function.
13016 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13017 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13018 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13019 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13020 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
13021 translation unit (an thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13022 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13023 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13024 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13025 that they *are* definitions).
13027 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13028 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13029 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13030 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13031 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
13032 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13033 return;
13035 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13036 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
13037 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
13038 if (decl_function_context (decl)
13039 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
13040 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13041 context_die = NULL;
13042 break;
13044 case VAR_DECL:
13045 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13046 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13047 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
13048 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13049 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
13050 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13051 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13052 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
13053 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13054 return;
13056 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13057 variable declarations or definitions. */
13058 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13059 return;
13060 break;
13062 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13063 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13064 return;
13065 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13066 return;
13067 break;
13069 case TYPE_DECL:
13070 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
13071 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13072 return;
13074 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13075 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
13076 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13078 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13079 comparisons have. */
13080 if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
13081 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
13082 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13083 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13084 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13086 return;
13089 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
13090 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13091 return;
13093 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13094 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
13095 if (decl_function_context (decl))
13096 context_die = NULL;
13098 break;
13100 default:
13101 return;
13104 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13107 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13108 a lexical block. */
13110 static void
13111 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13112 unsigned int blocknum)
13114 current_function_section (current_function_decl);
13115 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13118 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13119 lexical block. */
13121 static void
13122 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13124 current_function_section (current_function_decl);
13125 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13128 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13129 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13131 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13132 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13133 we may end up calling them anyway. */
13135 static bool
13136 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13138 tree decl;
13140 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13141 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13142 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13143 return 0;
13145 return 1;
13148 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13149 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
13150 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
13151 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13152 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13153 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
13154 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13155 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
13156 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
13157 all searches. */
13159 static unsigned
13160 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13162 size_t i, n;
13163 char *save_file_name;
13165 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13166 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
13167 if (file_table_last_lookup_index != 0)
13169 const char *last
13170 = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, file_table_last_lookup_index);
13171 if (strcmp (file_name, last) == 0)
13172 return file_table_last_lookup_index;
13175 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
13176 n = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table);
13177 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
13178 if (strcmp (file_name, VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)) == 0)
13180 file_table_last_lookup_index = i;
13181 return i;
13184 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
13185 file_table_last_lookup_index = n;
13186 save_file_name = (char *) ggc_strdup (file_name);
13187 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, save_file_name);
13188 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13190 /* If the assembler is emitting the file table, and we aren't eliminating
13191 unused debug types, then we must emit .file here. If we are eliminating
13192 unused debug types, then this will be done by the maybe_emit_file call in
13193 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs. */
13195 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && ! flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
13196 maybe_emit_file (i);
13198 return i;
13201 static int
13202 maybe_emit_file (int fileno)
13204 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && fileno > 0)
13206 if (!VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno))
13208 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno) = ++emitcount;
13209 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ",
13210 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno));
13211 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
13212 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, fileno));
13213 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13215 return VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno);
13217 else
13218 return fileno;
13221 static void
13222 init_file_table (void)
13224 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
13225 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR_INIT (file_table, 64, "file_table");
13226 VARRAY_UINT_INIT (file_table_emitted, 64, "file_table_emitted");
13228 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
13229 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, NULL);
13230 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
13231 file_table_last_lookup_index = 0;
13234 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
13235 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13236 our lookup table. */
13238 static void
13239 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13241 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13242 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13243 rtx prev_insn;
13244 static rtx last_insn;
13245 static const char *last_label;
13246 tree decl;
13248 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13249 return;
13250 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13252 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13253 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13254 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13255 last time. */
13256 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13257 && last_insn == prev_insn
13258 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13259 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13261 newloc->label = last_label;
13263 else
13265 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13266 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13267 loclabel_num++;
13268 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13270 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13271 newloc->next = NULL;
13273 if (cfun
13274 && (last_text_section == in_unlikely_executed_text
13275 || (last_text_section == in_named
13276 && last_text_section_name == cfun->unlikely_text_section_name)))
13277 newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13278 else
13279 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13281 last_insn = loc_note;
13282 last_label = newloc->label;
13283 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13284 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl) && DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl)
13285 && DECL_P (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl)))
13286 decl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
13287 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13290 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13291 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13292 declarations that use the locations won't have been outputted when
13293 that hook is called. */
13295 static void
13296 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13298 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13301 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13302 and record information relating to this source line, in
13303 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
13305 static void
13306 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13308 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13309 && line != 0)
13311 current_function_section (current_function_decl);
13313 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
13314 if (flag_debug_asm)
13315 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13316 filename, line);
13318 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13320 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13322 file_num = maybe_emit_file (file_num);
13324 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
13325 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13327 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
13328 line_info_table_in_use++;
13330 /* Indicate that multiple line number tables exist. */
13331 if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
13332 separate_line_info_table_in_use++;
13334 else if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
13336 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13337 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13338 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13340 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13341 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13342 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13344 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13345 separate_line_info_table
13346 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13347 separate_line_info_table_allocated
13348 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13349 memset (separate_line_info_table
13350 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13352 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13353 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13356 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13357 line_info
13358 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13359 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13360 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13361 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13363 else
13365 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13367 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13368 line_info_table_in_use);
13370 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13371 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13373 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13374 line_info_table
13375 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13376 (line_info_table_allocated
13377 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13378 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13379 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13382 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13383 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13384 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
13385 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13390 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
13392 static void
13393 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13395 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13397 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
13398 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13400 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13401 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13404 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13406 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13407 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13408 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13409 lineno);
13410 maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13411 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lookup_filename (filename),
13412 "Filename we just started");
13416 /* Record the end of a source file. */
13418 static void
13419 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13421 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13422 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
13423 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13425 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13427 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13428 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13432 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13433 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13434 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13436 static void
13437 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13438 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13440 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13442 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13443 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13444 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13445 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13449 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13450 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13451 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13453 static void
13454 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13455 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13457 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13459 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13460 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13461 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13462 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13466 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
13468 static void
13469 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13471 init_file_table ();
13473 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
13474 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13475 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13477 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
13478 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13479 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13481 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
13482 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13484 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
13485 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13486 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13487 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13488 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13489 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13491 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
13492 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13493 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13494 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13496 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13497 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13499 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
13500 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13501 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13502 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13503 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
13504 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
13505 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
13507 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
13509 VARRAY_RTX_INIT (used_rtx_varray, 32, "used_rtx_varray");
13511 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13512 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
13513 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13514 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13515 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
13516 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13517 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13519 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
13520 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13521 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
13522 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13523 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
13524 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13525 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13526 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
13527 named_section_flags (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13528 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
13529 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13530 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
13532 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13534 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13535 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
13536 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13537 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
13540 text_section ();
13541 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
13542 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
13544 unlikely_text_section ();
13545 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
13549 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
13550 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
13552 static int
13553 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13555 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
13557 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
13559 named_section_flags (DEBUG_STR_SECTION, DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS);
13560 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
13561 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
13564 return 1;
13569 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
13570 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
13572 static void
13573 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
13575 dw_die_ref c;
13576 die->die_mark = 0;
13577 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13578 prune_unmark_dies (c);
13582 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
13583 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
13585 static void
13586 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
13588 dw_attr_ref a;
13590 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
13592 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
13594 /* A reference to another DIE.
13595 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
13596 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
13598 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file)
13600 /* A reference to a file. Make sure the file name is emitted. */
13601 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned =
13602 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
13608 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
13609 to DIE's children. */
13611 static void
13612 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
13614 dw_die_ref c;
13616 if (die->die_mark == 0)
13618 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
13619 die->die_mark = 1;
13621 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
13622 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
13623 if (die->die_parent)
13624 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
13626 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
13627 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13629 /* If this node is a specification,
13630 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
13631 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
13632 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
13635 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
13637 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
13638 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
13639 die->die_mark = 2;
13641 /* Walk them. */
13642 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13644 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
13645 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
13646 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
13647 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
13648 else
13649 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
13655 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
13657 static void
13658 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
13660 dw_die_ref c;
13662 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
13663 if (die->die_mark)
13664 return;
13666 switch (die->die_tag) {
13667 case DW_TAG_const_type:
13668 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
13669 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
13670 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
13671 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
13672 case DW_TAG_typedef:
13673 case DW_TAG_array_type:
13674 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
13675 case DW_TAG_union_type:
13676 case DW_TAG_class_type:
13677 case DW_TAG_friend:
13678 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
13679 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
13680 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
13681 case DW_TAG_string_type:
13682 case DW_TAG_set_type:
13683 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
13684 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
13685 case DW_TAG_file_type:
13686 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
13687 return;
13689 default:
13690 /* Mark everything else. */
13691 break;
13694 die->die_mark = 1;
13696 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
13697 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
13699 /* Mark children. */
13700 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
13701 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
13705 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
13707 static void
13708 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
13710 dw_die_ref c, p, n;
13712 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
13714 p = NULL;
13715 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = n)
13717 n = c->die_sib;
13718 if (c->die_mark)
13720 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
13721 p = c;
13723 else
13725 if (p)
13726 p->die_sib = n;
13727 else
13728 die->die_child = n;
13729 free_die (c);
13735 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
13737 static void
13738 prune_unused_types (void)
13740 unsigned int i;
13741 limbo_die_node *node;
13743 /* Clear all the marks. */
13744 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
13745 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13746 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
13748 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
13749 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
13750 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13751 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
13753 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
13754 pubname_table or arange_table. */
13755 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
13756 prune_unused_types_mark (pubname_table[i].die, 1);
13757 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
13758 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
13760 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked. */
13761 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
13762 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13763 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
13765 /* Leave the marks clear. */
13766 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
13767 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13768 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
13771 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
13772 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
13774 static void
13775 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
13777 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
13778 dw_die_ref die = 0;
13780 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
13781 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
13782 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
13783 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
13784 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
13785 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
13787 size_t i;
13788 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
13789 if (VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR
13790 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
13791 && VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != '<')
13793 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
13794 break;
13798 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
13799 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
13800 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
13801 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
13802 instance. */
13803 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
13805 next_node = node->next;
13806 die = node->die;
13808 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
13810 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
13812 if (origin)
13813 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
13814 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
13816 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
13817 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
13818 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
13819 else
13821 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
13822 nested function can be optimized away, which results
13823 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
13824 with the return type of that nested function. Force
13825 this to be a child of the containing function.
13827 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
13828 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
13829 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
13830 the function is likely unreachable too. */
13831 tree context = NULL_TREE;
13833 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
13835 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
13836 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
13837 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
13838 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
13840 gcc_assert (context && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL);
13842 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
13843 if (origin)
13844 add_child_die (origin, die);
13845 else
13846 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
13851 limbo_die_list = NULL;
13853 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
13854 emit full debugging info for them. */
13855 retry_incomplete_types ();
13857 /* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
13858 we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
13859 reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
13861 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
13862 prune_unused_types ();
13864 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
13865 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
13866 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13867 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
13869 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
13870 that have children. */
13871 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
13872 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13873 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
13875 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
13876 text_section ();
13877 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13878 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
13880 unlikely_text_section ();
13881 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13884 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
13885 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
13886 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
13887 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
13888 examining the file. */
13889 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13891 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13892 output_line_info ();
13895 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
13896 if (have_location_lists)
13898 /* Output the location lists info. */
13899 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13900 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
13901 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13902 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
13903 output_location_lists (die);
13904 have_location_lists = 0;
13907 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
13908 in .text. */
13909 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
13911 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
13912 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
13915 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
13916 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
13917 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
13918 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
13920 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13921 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
13922 debug_line_section_label);
13924 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13925 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
13927 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
13928 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
13929 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
13930 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
13932 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
13934 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
13935 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13936 output_abbrev_section ();
13938 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
13939 if (pubname_table_in_use)
13941 named_section_flags (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13942 output_pubnames ();
13945 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
13946 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
13947 if (fde_table_in_use)
13949 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13950 output_aranges ();
13953 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
13954 if (ranges_table_in_use)
13956 named_section_flags (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13957 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
13958 output_ranges ();
13961 /* Have to end the macro section. */
13962 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13964 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
13965 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
13968 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
13969 table too. */
13970 if (debug_str_hash)
13971 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
13973 #else
13975 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
13976 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
13978 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
13980 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"